blob: dcc87fdc09ea5a86c99ae2e1155b7d06cd82e3b3 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaub3066502017-11-26 19:50:17 +01005 version 1.9
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau0b787922017-11-26 19:25:23 +01007 2017/11/26
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011110. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011210.1. Limitation
11310.2. Setup
11410.2.1. Cache section
11510.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116
1171. Quick reminder about HTTP
118----------------------------
119
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100120When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
122on almost anything found in the contents.
123
124However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
125formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
126correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
127
128
1291.1. The HTTP transaction model
130-------------------------------
131
132The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100133to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
135connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136will involve a new connection :
137
138 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
139
140In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
141establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
142by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
143length.
144
145Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
146to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
147however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
148response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
149header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
154power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
155but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200156a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100158Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
160second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
161page :
162
163 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
164
165This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
166latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
167correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
168the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100169server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
172time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
173are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
174parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
175carry the stream identifier.
176
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100177By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
178connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
179leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100180start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
181processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
182waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200183
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100184HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
185 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
186 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
187 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
188 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
190 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
371 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
480which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
481
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
4832.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200484----------------
485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100486Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100487values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
488otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
489numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
490for every keyword. Supported units are :
491
492 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
493 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
494 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
495 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
496 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
497 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
498
499
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005002.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200501-------------
502
503 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
504 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
505 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
506 global
507 daemon
508 maxconn 256
509
510 defaults
511 mode http
512 timeout connect 5000ms
513 timeout client 50000ms
514 timeout server 50000ms
515
516 frontend http-in
517 bind *:80
518 default_backend servers
519
520 backend servers
521 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
522
523
524 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
525 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
526 global
527 daemon
528 maxconn 256
529
530 defaults
531 mode http
532 timeout connect 5000ms
533 timeout client 50000ms
534 timeout server 50000ms
535
536 listen http-in
537 bind *:80
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
542
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100543 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200544
545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547--------------------
548
549Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
550are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
551of them have command-line equivalents.
552
553The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
554
555 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200556 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200558 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200559 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200561 - description
562 - deviceatlas-json-file
563 - deviceatlas-log-level
564 - deviceatlas-separator
565 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900566 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - gid
568 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100569 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100572 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200575 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100578 - presetenv
579 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580 - uid
581 - ulimit-n
582 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100583 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200584 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
586 - ssl-default-bind-options
587 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
588 - ssl-default-server-options
589 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100590 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100591 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100592 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100593 - 51degrees-data-file
594 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200595 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200596 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100597 - wurfl-data-file
598 - wurfl-information-list
599 - wurfl-information-list-separator
600 - wurfl-engine-mode
601 - wurfl-cache-size
602 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100603
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200604 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200605 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200607 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100608 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100609 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100610 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200611 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200612 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200613 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200614 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200615 - noepoll
616 - nokqueue
617 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100618 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300619 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000620 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200621 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200622 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200623 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000624 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000625 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - tune.buffers.limit
627 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200628 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200629 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100630 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200631 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200632 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200633 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100634 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200635 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200636 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100637 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100638 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100639 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100640 - tune.lua.session-timeout
641 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200642 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100643 - tune.maxaccept
644 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200645 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200646 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200647 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100648 - tune.rcvbuf.client
649 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100650 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100651 - tune.sndbuf.client
652 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100653 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100654 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200655 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100656 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200657 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200658 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100659 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200660 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100661 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200662 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
663 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
664 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100665 - tune.zlib.memlevel
666 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100667
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200668 * Debugging
669 - debug
670 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200671
672
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006733.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674------------------------------------
675
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200676ca-base <dir>
677 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200678 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
679 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200680
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200681chroot <jail dir>
682 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
683 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
684 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
685 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
686 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100687 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100688
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100689cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
690 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
691 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
692 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
693 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
694 set. These sets have the format
695
696 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
697
698 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100699 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100700 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
701 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100702 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
703 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100704 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100705 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100706 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100707 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100708 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
709 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
710 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
711 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100712
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100713 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
714 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
715 on the machine's word size.
716
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100717 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100718 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
719 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
720 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
721 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
722 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
723 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100724
725 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100726 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
727
728 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
729 # first 4 CPUs
730
731 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
732 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
733 # word size.
734
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100735 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100736 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100737 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
738 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
739 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
740
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100741 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
742 # and so on.
743 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
744 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
745 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
746
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100747 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100748 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
749 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
750 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
751
752 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
753 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
754 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
755
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100756 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
757 # and a thread range.
758 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
759 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
760 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
761
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200762crt-base <dir>
763 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
764 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
765 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
766
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200767daemon
768 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
769 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100770 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
771 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200772
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200773deviceatlas-json-file <path>
774 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100775 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200776
777deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100778 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200779 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
780
781deviceatlas-separator <char>
782 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
783 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
784
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100785deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200786 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
787 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
788 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100789
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900790external-check
791 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
792 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
793 See "option external-check".
794
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200795gid <number>
796 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
797 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
798 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100799 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
800 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200801 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100802
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100803hard-stop-after <time>
804 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
805
806 Arguments :
807 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
808 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
809 SIGUSR1 signal.
810
811 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
812 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
813 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
814
815 Example:
816 global
817 hard-stop-after 30s
818
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819group <group name>
820 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
821 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100822
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200823log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100824 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100825 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100826 configured with "log global".
827
828 <address> can be one of:
829
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100830 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100831 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
832 port).
833
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100834 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
835 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
836 port).
837
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100838 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
839 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
840 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100841 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100842
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200843 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
844 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100845
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200846 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
847 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
848 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
849 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
850 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
851 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
852 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
853 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
854 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
855 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100856 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
857 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200858
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200859 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
860 one of the following :
861
862 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
863 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
864
865 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
866 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
867
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100868 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200869
870 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
871 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
872 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
873
874 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200875 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
876 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
877 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
878 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
879 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
880 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200881
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200882 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200883
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100884log-send-hostname [<string>]
885 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
886 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
887 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
888 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
889 the logs.
890
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000891log-tag <string>
892 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
893 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
894 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100895 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000896
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100897lua-load <file>
898 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
899 used multiple times.
900
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100901master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200902 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
903 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
904 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100905 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200906 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
907 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100908 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
909 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
910 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
911 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
912 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200913
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100914 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200915
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200916nbproc <number>
917 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
918 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
919 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
920 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
921 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
922
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200923nbthread <number>
924 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
925 creates <number> threads for each created processes. It means if HAProxy is
926 started in foreground, it only creates <number> threads for the first
927 process. FOR NOW, THREADS SUPPORT IN HAPROXY IS HIGHLY EXPERIMENTAL AND IT
928 MUST BE ENABLED WITH CAUTION AND AT YOUR OWN RISK. See also "nbproc".
929
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200930pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100931 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200932 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
933 starting the process. See also "daemon".
934
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100935presetenv <name> <value>
936 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
937 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
938 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
939 and "unsetenv".
940
941resetenv [<name> ...]
942 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
943 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
944 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
945 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
946 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
947 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
948 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
949 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
950
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100951stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200952 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
953 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
954 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
955 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
956 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
957 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100958 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100959 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
960 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
961 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
962 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200963
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200964server-state-base <directory>
965 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200966 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
967 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200968
969server-state-file <file>
970 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
971 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
972 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
973 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
974 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
975 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
976 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
977 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200978 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
979 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200980
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100981setenv <name> <value>
982 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
983 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
984 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
985 and "unsetenv".
986
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100987ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
988 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
989 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300990 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100991 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
992 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
993 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
994 "bind" keyword for more information.
995
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100996ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
997 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
998 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
999 keyword to see available options.
1000
1001 Example:
1002 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001003 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001004
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001005ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1006 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1007 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001008 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001009 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
1010 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
1011 information.
1012
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001013ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1014 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1015 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1016 keyword to see available options.
1017
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001018ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1019 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1020 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1021 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001022 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001023 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001024 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1025 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1026 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1027 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001028 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1029 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1030 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1031
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001032ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1033 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1034 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1035 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1036
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001037stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1038 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1039 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1040 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001041 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001042 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001043
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001044 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1045 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1046 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001047
1048stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1049 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1050 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001051 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001052
1053stats maxconn <connections>
1054 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1055 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1056
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001057uid <number>
1058 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1059 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1060 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1061 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1062
1063ulimit-n <number>
1064 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1065 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1066 option.
1067
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001068unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1069 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1070
1071 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1072 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1073 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1074 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1075 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1076 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1077 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1078 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1079 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1080 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1081
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001082unsetenv [<name> ...]
1083 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1084 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1085 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1086 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1087 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1088 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1089 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1090
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001091user <user name>
1092 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1093 See also "uid" and "group".
1094
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001095node <name>
1096 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1097
1098 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1099 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1100 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1101 traffic.
1102
1103description <text>
1104 Add a text that describes the instance.
1105
1106 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1107 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1108 "<" and ">" characters.
1109
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100111051degrees-data-file <file path>
1111 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001112 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001113
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001114 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001115 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1116
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000111751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001118 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1119 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1120 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1121
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001122 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001123 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1124
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200112551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001126 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1127 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1128
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001129 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1130 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1131
113251degrees-cache-size <number>
1133 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1134 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1135 By default, this cache is disabled.
1136
1137 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001138 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1139
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001140wurfl-data-file <file path>
1141 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1142 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1143
1144 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1145 with USE_WURFL=1.
1146
1147wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1148 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1149 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1150 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1151
1152 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1153
1154 Valid WURFL properties are:
1155 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1156
1157 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1158 device.
1159
1160 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1161 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1162
1163 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1164 particular web request.
1165
1166 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1167 used Libwurfl API version.
1168
1169 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1170 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1171 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1172
1173 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1174 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1175
1176 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1177 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1178
1179 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1180
1181 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1182
1183 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1184 with USE_WURFL=1.
1185
1186wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1187 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1188 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1189
1190 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1191 with USE_WURFL=1.
1192
1193wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1194 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1195 thus before the chroot.
1196
1197 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1198 with USE_WURFL=1.
1199
1200wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1201 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1202 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001203 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001204 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001205 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001206 mode is enabled by default.
1207
1208 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1209 with USE_WURFL=1.
1210
1211wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1212 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1213 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1214 - "0" : no cache is used.
1215 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1216 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1217 the highest performing option.
1218
1219 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1220 with USE_WURFL=1.
1221
1222wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1223 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1224 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1225
1226 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1227 with USE_WURFL=1.
1228
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001229
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012303.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001231-----------------------
1232
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001233max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1234 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1235 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1236 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1237 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1238 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1239 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1240 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1241 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1242
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001243maxconn <number>
1244 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1245 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1246 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001247 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1248 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1249 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1250 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001251 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1252 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1253 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1254 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1255 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001256
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001257maxconnrate <number>
1258 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1259 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1260 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1261 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1262 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1263 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1264 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1265 fairness.
1266
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001267maxcomprate <number>
1268 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001269 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001270 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1271 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1272 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001273 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001274 default value.
1275
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001276maxcompcpuusage <number>
1277 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1278 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1279 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1280 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1281 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1282 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1283 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1284 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1285
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001286maxpipes <number>
1287 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1288 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1289 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1290 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1291 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1292 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1293
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001294maxsessrate <number>
1295 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1296 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1297 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1298 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1299 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1300 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1301 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1302 fairness.
1303
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001304maxsslconn <number>
1305 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1306 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1307 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1308 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1309 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1310 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1311 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001312 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1313 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1314 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1315 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1316 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1317 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1318 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001319
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001320maxsslrate <number>
1321 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1322 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1323 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1324 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1325 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1326 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1327 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1328 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1329 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1330 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1331
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001332maxzlibmem <number>
1333 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1334 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1335 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001336 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1337 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1338 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1339
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001340noepoll
1341 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1342 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001343 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001344
1345nokqueue
1346 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1347 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1348 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1349
1350nopoll
1351 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1352 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001353 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001354 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001355
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001356nosplice
1357 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001358 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001359 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001360 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001361 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1362 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1363 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1364 "option splice-response".
1365
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001366nogetaddrinfo
1367 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1368 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1369
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001370noreuseport
1371 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1372 command line argument "-dR".
1373
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001374spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001375 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1376 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1377 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1378 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1379 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1380 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001381
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001382ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001383 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001384 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001385 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1386 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1387 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1388 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1389 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001390 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1391 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001392 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1393 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1394 openssl configuration file uses:
1395 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1396
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001397ssl-mode-async
1398 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001399 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001400 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1401 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1402 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1403 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1404 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001405
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001406tune.buffers.limit <number>
1407 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1408 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1409 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1410 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1411 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001412 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001413 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1414 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1415 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1416 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1417 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1418 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1419 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1420 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1421 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1422
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001423tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1424 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1425 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1426 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1427 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1428
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001429tune.bufsize <number>
1430 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1431 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1432 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1433 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1434 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1435 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1436 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001437 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1438 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1439 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001440 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1441 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001442
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001443tune.chksize <number>
1444 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1445 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1446 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1447 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1448 checks whenever possible.
1449
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001450tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1451 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1452 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1453 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1454 this value. The default value is 1.
1455
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001456tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1457 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1458 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1459 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1460 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1461 change it.
1462
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001463tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1464 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001465 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1466 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001467 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1468 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1469 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1470 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1471 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1472
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001473tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1474 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1475 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1476 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1477 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1478 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1479 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1480 recommended not to change this value.
1481
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001482tune.http.cookielen <number>
1483 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1484 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1485 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1486 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1487 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1488 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1489 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1490 to change this value.
1491
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001492tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001493 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1494 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001495 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001496 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001497 configuration directives too.
1498 The default value is 1024.
1499
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001500tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1501 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1502 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1503 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1504 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1505 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1506 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001507 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1508 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1509 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001510
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001511tune.idletimer <timeout>
1512 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1513 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1514 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1515 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1516 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1517 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001518 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001519 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1520 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1521
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001522tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1523 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001524 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001525 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1526 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001527 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001528 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1529 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1530
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001531tune.lua.maxmem
1532 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1533 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1534 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1535 memory.
1536
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001537tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1538 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001539 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1540 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001541 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001542
1543tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1544 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1545 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1546 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1547 check servers.
1548
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001549tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1550 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1551 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1552 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001553 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001554
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001555tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001556 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1557 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1558 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1559 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1560 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1561 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1562 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1563 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1564 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1565 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001566
1567tune.maxpollevents <number>
1568 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1569 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1570 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1571 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1572 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1573
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001574tune.maxrewrite <number>
1575 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1576 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1577 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1578 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1579 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1580 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1581 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1582 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1583 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1584 bufsize.
1585
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001586tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1587 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1588 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1589 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1590 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1591 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1592 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1593 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1594 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1595 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1596 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1597 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1598 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1599 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1600 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1601 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1602 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1603 setting this parameter to 0.
1604
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001605tune.pipesize <number>
1606 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1607 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1608 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1609 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1610 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1611 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1612
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001613tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1614tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1615 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1616 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1617 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1618 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001619 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001620 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1621 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1622
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001623tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001624 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001625 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1626 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1627 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1628 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1629
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001630tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1631tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1632 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1633 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1634 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1635 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001636 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001637 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1638 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1639 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1640 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1641 notifying haproxy again.
1642
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001643tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001644 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1645 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1646 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001647 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001648 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001649 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001650 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1651 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1652 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001653 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1654 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001655
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001656tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1657 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1658 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1659 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1660 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1661 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1662 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1663
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001664tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1665 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001666 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001667 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1668 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1669 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1670 being used for too long.
1671
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001672tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1673 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1674 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1675 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1676 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1677 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1678 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1679 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1680 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1681 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1682 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001683 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001684 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001685
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001686tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1687 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1688 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1689 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1690 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1691 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1692 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1693 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001694 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1695 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001696
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001697tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1698 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1699 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1700 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1701 1000 entries.
1702
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001703tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1704 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1705 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1706 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1707
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001708tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001709tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001710tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1711tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1712tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001713 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1714 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1715 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1716 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1717 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1718 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1719 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1720 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001721
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001722 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1723 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1724 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1725 all available space is consumed.
1726 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1727 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1728 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001729
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001730tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1731 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001732 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001733 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001734 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001735 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1736
1737tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1738 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1739 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001740 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1741 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001742
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017433.3. Debugging
1744--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001745
1746debug
1747 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1748 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1749 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1750 system startup.
1751
1752quiet
1753 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1754 line argument "-q".
1755
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001756
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017573.4. Userlists
1758--------------
1759It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1760http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1761it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1762
1763userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001764 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001765 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1766
1767group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001768 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001769 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1770 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1771
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001772user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1773 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001774 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1775 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001776 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1777 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1778 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1779 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001780
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001781 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1782 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1783 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1784 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1785 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1786 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1787 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1788 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1789 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001790
1791 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001792 userlist L1
1793 group G1 users tiger,scott
1794 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001795
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001796 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1797 user scott insecure-password elgato
1798 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001799
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001800 userlist L2
1801 group G1
1802 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001803
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001804 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1805 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1806 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001807
1808 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001809
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001810
18113.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001812----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001813It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1814several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1815instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1816values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1817automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1818In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1819using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1820tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1821reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1822Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1823that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1824each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001825
1826peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001827 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001828 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1829
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001830disabled
1831 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1832 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1833 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1834
1835enable
1836 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1837
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001838peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1839 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1840 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1841 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1842 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1843 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1844 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1845
1846 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1847 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1848
1849 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1850 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1851 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1852 across all peers.
1853
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001854 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1855 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001856
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001857 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001858 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001859 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1860 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1861 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001862
1863 backend mybackend
1864 mode tcp
1865 balance roundrobin
1866 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1867 stick on src
1868
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001869 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1870 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001871
1872
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090018733.6. Mailers
1874------------
1875It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1876If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1877in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1878
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001879mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001880 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1881 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1882
1883mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1884 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1885
1886 Example:
1887 mailers mymailers
1888 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1889 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1890
1891 backend mybackend
1892 mode tcp
1893 balance roundrobin
1894
1895 email-alert mailers mymailers
1896 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1897 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1898
1899 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1900 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1901
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001902timeout mail <time>
1903 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1904 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1905 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1906 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1907
1908 Example:
1909 mailers mymailers
1910 timeout mail 20s
1911 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001912
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019134. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001914----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001915
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001916Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001917 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001918 - frontend <name>
1919 - backend <name>
1920 - listen <name>
1921
1922A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1923its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1924section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001925section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001926
1927A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1928connections.
1929
1930A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1931to forward incoming connections.
1932
1933A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1934parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1935
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001936All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1937'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1938case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1939
1940Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1941logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1942proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1943However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1944name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1945
1946Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1947and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001948bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001949protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1950modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1951arbitrary criteria.
1952
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001953In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1954a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1955the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1956
1957 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1958 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1959 between responses and new requests.
1960
1961 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1962 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1963 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1964 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1965
1966 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1967 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1968 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1969
1970 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1971 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1972 client-facing connection remains open.
1973
1974 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1975 after the end of the response.
1976
1977The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1978frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1979following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1980weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1981
1982 Backend mode
1983
1984 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1985 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1986 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1987 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1988 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1989 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1990 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1991 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1992 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1993 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1994 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1995
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001996
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001997
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019984.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1999--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002001The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2002limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2003they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2004limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002005marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002006option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002007and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2008with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2009specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002010
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002011
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002012 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2013------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2014acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002015appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002016backlog X X X -
2017balance X - X X
2018bind - X X -
2019bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002020block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002021capture cookie - X X -
2022capture request header - X X -
2023capture response header - X X -
2024clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002025compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002026contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2027cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002028declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002029default-server X - X X
2030default_backend X X X -
2031description - X X X
2032disabled X X X X
2033dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002034email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002035email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002036email-alert mailers X X X X
2037email-alert myhostname X X X X
2038email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002039enabled X X X X
2040errorfile X X X X
2041errorloc X X X X
2042errorloc302 X X X X
2043-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2044errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002045force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002046filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002047fullconn X - X X
2048grace X X X X
2049hash-type X - X X
2050http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002051http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002052http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002053http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002054http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002055http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002056http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002057id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002058ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002059load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002060log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002061log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002062log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002063log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002064max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002065maxconn X X X -
2066mode X X X X
2067monitor fail - X X -
2068monitor-net X X X -
2069monitor-uri X X X -
2070option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2071option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2072option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2073option allbackups (*) X - X X
2074option checkcache (*) X - X X
2075option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2076option contstats (*) X X X -
2077option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2078option dontlognull (*) X X X -
2079option forceclose (*) X X X X
2080-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2081option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002082option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002083option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002084option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002085option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002086option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002087option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01002088option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002089option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2090option httpchk X - X X
2091option httpclose (*) X X X X
2092option httplog X X X X
2093option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002094option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002095option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002096option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002097option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2098option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2099option logasap (*) X X X -
2100option mysql-check X - X X
2101option nolinger (*) X X X X
2102option originalto X X X X
2103option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002104option pgsql-check X - X X
2105option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002106option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002107option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002108option smtpchk X - X X
2109option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2110option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2111option splice-request (*) X X X X
2112option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002113option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002114option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2115option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2116-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002117option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002118option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2119option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2120option tcpka X X X X
2121option tcplog X X X X
2122option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002123external-check command X - X X
2124external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002125persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2126rate-limit sessions X X X -
2127redirect - X X X
2128redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2129redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2130reqadd - X X X
2131reqallow - X X X
2132reqdel - X X X
2133reqdeny - X X X
2134reqiallow - X X X
2135reqidel - X X X
2136reqideny - X X X
2137reqipass - X X X
2138reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002139reqitarpit - X X X
2140reqpass - X X X
2141reqrep - X X X
2142-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002143reqtarpit - X X X
2144retries X - X X
2145rspadd - X X X
2146rspdel - X X X
2147rspdeny - X X X
2148rspidel - X X X
2149rspideny - X X X
2150rspirep - X X X
2151rsprep - X X X
2152server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002153server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002154server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002155source X - X X
2156srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002157stats admin - X X X
2158stats auth X X X X
2159stats enable X X X X
2160stats hide-version X X X X
2161stats http-request - X X X
2162stats realm X X X X
2163stats refresh X X X X
2164stats scope X X X X
2165stats show-desc X X X X
2166stats show-legends X X X X
2167stats show-node X X X X
2168stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002169-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2170stick match - - X X
2171stick on - - X X
2172stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002173stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002174stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002175tcp-check connect - - X X
2176tcp-check expect - - X X
2177tcp-check send - - X X
2178tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002179tcp-request connection - X X -
2180tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002181tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002182tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002183tcp-response content - - X X
2184tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002185timeout check X - X X
2186timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002187timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002188timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2189timeout connect X - X X
2190timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2191timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2192timeout http-request X X X X
2193timeout queue X - X X
2194timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002195timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002196timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2197timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002198timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002199transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002200unique-id-format X X X -
2201unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002202use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002203use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002204------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2205 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002206
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002207
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022084.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2209---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002210
2211This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2212
2213
2214acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2215 Declare or complete an access list.
2216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2217 no | yes | yes | yes
2218 Example:
2219 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2220 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2221 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002223 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002224
2225
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002226appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2227 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002228 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2230 no | no | yes | yes
2231 Arguments :
2232 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2233 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2234
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002235 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002236 checked in each cookie value.
2237
2238 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2239 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2240 milliseconds.
2241
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002242 request-learn
2243 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2244 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2245 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2246 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2247 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2248 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2249
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002250 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2251 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2252 data following this prefix.
2253
2254 Example :
2255 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2256
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002257 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXX=XXXX,
2258 the appsession value will be XXX=XXXX.
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002259
2260 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2261 2 modes are currently supported :
2262 - path-parameters :
2263 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2264 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2265 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2266 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2267 - query-string :
2268 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2269 query string.
2270
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002271 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2272 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2273 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002274
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002275 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2276 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002277
2278
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002279backlog <conns>
2280 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2282 yes | yes | yes | no
2283 Arguments :
2284 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2285 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002286 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002287
2288 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2289 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2290 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2291 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2292 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2293 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2294 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2295 backlog parameter.
2296
2297 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2298 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2299 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2300
2301 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2302
2303
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002304balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002305balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002306 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2308 yes | no | yes | yes
2309 Arguments :
2310 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2311 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2312 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2313 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2314
2315 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2316 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2317 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2318 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002319 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002320 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002321 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2322 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2323 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2324 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2325 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2326 it, so that you don't worry.
2327
2328 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2329 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2330 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2331 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2332 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2333 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2334 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2335 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002336
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002337 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2338 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2339 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2340 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2341 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2342 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2343 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2344 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2345
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002346 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002347 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002348 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2349 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002350 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002351 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2352 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2353 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2354 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2355 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002356 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2357 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2358 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2359 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2360 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2361 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002362
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002363 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2364 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2365 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2366 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2367 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2368 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2369 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2370 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002371 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002372 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002373 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2374 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2375 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002376
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002377 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2378 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2379 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2380 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2381 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2382 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2383 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2384 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2385 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2386 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2387 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2388 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002389
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002390 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002391 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2392 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2393 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2394 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2395 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2396 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2397 URIs start with a leading "/".
2398
2399 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2400 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2401 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2402 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2403
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002404 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002405 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2406
2407 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002408 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2409 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002410 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2411 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2412 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2413 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002414 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002415 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2416 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002417
2418 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2419 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2420 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2421 server will receive the request.
2422
2423 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2424 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2425 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2426 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2427 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002428 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2429 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2430 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002431
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002432 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2433 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2434 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2435 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2436 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002438 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002439 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2440 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2441 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2442
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002443 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2444 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2445 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2446
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002447 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002448 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002449 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2450 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2451 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2452 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2453 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2454 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002455 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002456 used instead.
2457
2458 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2459 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2460 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2461 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2462
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002463 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2464 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2465 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2466
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002467 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002468
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002469 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002470 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2471 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002472
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002473 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2474 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2475 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002476
2477 Examples :
2478 balance roundrobin
2479 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002480 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002481 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2482 balance hdr(host)
2483 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002484
2485 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2486 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2487
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002488 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002489 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2490 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2491 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2492 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2493
2494 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2495 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2496 defaults to 16 kB.
2497
2498 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2499 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2500
2501 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2502 Round Robin.
2503
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002504 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002505 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2506 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2507 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2508
2509 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2510
2511 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002512 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002513 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2514 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2515 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002516
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002517 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002518
2519
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002520bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2521bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002522 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2524 no | yes | yes | no
2525 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002526 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2527 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2528 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2529 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002530 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002531 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2532 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2533 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2534 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2535 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2536 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2537 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002538 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2539 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2540 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2541 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2542 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2543 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2544 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002545 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2546 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2547 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002548 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2549 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2550 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002551
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002552 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2553 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002554 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2555 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2556 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002557 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2558 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2559 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2560 the range.
2561
2562 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2563 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2564 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2565 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2566 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2567 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2568 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002569 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002570 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002571
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002572 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002573 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002574 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2575 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2576 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2577 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2578 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2579 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2580
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002581 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2582 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2583 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2584 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002585
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002586 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2587 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2588 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2589 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2590 in a frontend.
2591
2592 Example :
2593 listen http_proxy
2594 bind :80,:443
2595 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002596 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002597
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002598 listen http_https_proxy
2599 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002600 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002601
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002602 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2603 bind ipv6@:80
2604 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2605 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2606
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002607 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002608 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002609
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002610 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2611 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2612 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2613 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2614 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2615
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002616 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002617 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002618
2619
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002620bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002621 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2623 yes | yes | yes | yes
2624 Arguments :
2625 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2626 may be used to override a default value.
2627
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002628 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002629 option may be combined with other numbers.
2630
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002631 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002632 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2633 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2634 missing from all processes.
2635
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002636 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002637 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002638 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2639 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2640 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2641 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2642 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002643 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002644
2645 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2646 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2647 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2648 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2649 and 'even' instances.
2650
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002651 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2652 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2653 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2654 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002655
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002656 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2657 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2658
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002659 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2660 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2661 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2662
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002663 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2664 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2665
2666 Example :
2667 listen app_ip1
2668 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002669 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002670
2671 listen app_ip2
2672 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002673 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002674
2675 listen management
2676 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002677 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002678
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002679 listen management
2680 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2681 bind-process 1-4
2682
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002683 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002684
2685
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002686block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002687 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2689 no | yes | yes | yes
2690
2691 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2692 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002693 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002694 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002695 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002696 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2697 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2698 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002699
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002700 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2701 "http-request deny" instead.
2702
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002703 Example:
2704 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2705 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2706 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002707 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2708 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2709 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002710
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002711 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2712 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2713 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002714
2715capture cookie <name> len <length>
2716 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2718 no | yes | yes | no
2719 Arguments :
2720 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2721 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2722 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2723 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002724 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002725
2726 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2727 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2728 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2729 right if it exceeds <length>.
2730
2731 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2732 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2733 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2734 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2735
2736 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2737 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2738 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2739
2740 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2741 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2742 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002743 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2744 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2745 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002746
2747 Example:
2748 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2749
2750 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002751 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002752
2753
2754capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002755 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2757 no | yes | yes | no
2758 Arguments :
2759 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002760 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002761 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2762 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2763 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2764
2765 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2766 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2767 it exceeds <length>.
2768
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002769 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002770 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2771 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002772 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2773 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2774 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2775 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002776 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002777 environments to find where the request came from.
2778
2779 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2780 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2781 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2782 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002783
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002784 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2785 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2786 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2787 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2788 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002789
2790 Example:
2791 capture request header Host len 15
2792 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002793 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002794
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002795 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002796 about logging.
2797
2798
2799capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002800 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2802 no | yes | yes | no
2803 Arguments :
2804 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002805 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002806 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2807 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2808 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2809
2810 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2811 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2812 it exceeds <length>.
2813
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002814 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002815 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2816 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2817 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002818 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2819 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2820 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2821 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002822
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002823 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2824 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2825 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2826 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2827 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002828
2829 Example:
2830 capture response header Content-length len 9
2831 capture response header Location len 15
2832
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002833 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002834 about logging.
2835
2836
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002837clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002838 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2840 yes | yes | yes | no
2841 Arguments :
2842 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2843 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2844 as explained at the top of this document.
2845
2846 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2847 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2848 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2849 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2850 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2851 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2852 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2853 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002854 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002855 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002856 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002857
2858 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2859 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2860 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2861 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2862 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2863 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2864
2865 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2866 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2867
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002868 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2869 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002870
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002871compression algo <algorithm> ...
2872compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002873compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002874 Enable HTTP compression.
2875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2876 yes | yes | yes | yes
2877 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002878 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2879 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2880 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2881
2882 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002883 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2884 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2885 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002886
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002887 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002888 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002889
2890 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2891 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2892 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2893 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2894 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002895 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002896
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002897 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2898 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2899 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2900 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2901 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2902 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2903 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002904 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002905
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002906 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002907 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002908 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2909 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2910 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2911 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2912 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002913
2914 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2915 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2916 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2917 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2918 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002919 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2920 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2921 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2922 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2923 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002924 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2925 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002926
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002927 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002928 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2929 "Accept-Encoding" header
2930 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002931 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002932 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2933 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002934 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2935 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2936 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2937 "multipart"
2938 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2939 header
2940 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2941 and later
2942 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2943 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002944
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002945 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2946 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002947
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002948 Examples :
2949 compression algo gzip
2950 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002951
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002952
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002953contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002954 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2956 yes | no | yes | yes
2957 Arguments :
2958 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2959 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2960 as explained at the top of this document.
2961
2962 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002963 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002964 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002965 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002966 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2967 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2968 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2969
2970 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2971 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2972 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2973 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2974 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2975 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2976
2977 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2978 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2979 instead.
2980
2981 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2982 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2983
2984
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002985cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002986 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2987 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002988 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002989 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2991 yes | no | yes | yes
2992 Arguments :
2993 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2994 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2995 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2996 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2997 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2998 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002999 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003000 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3001 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3002
3003 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3004 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3005 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3006 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3007 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3008 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003009 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3010 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003011 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003012 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3013 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003014
3015 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003016 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003017
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003018 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003019 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3020 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003021 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003022 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3023 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3024 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3025 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3026 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3027 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3028 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003029
3030 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3031 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3032 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3033 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3034 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3035 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3036 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3037 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3038 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003039 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003040 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3041 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3042 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003043
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003044 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3045 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3046 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003047 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3048 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3049 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3050 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003051 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3052 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3053 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003054
3055 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3056 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3057 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3058 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3059 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3060 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3061 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3062 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3063 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3064
3065 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3066 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3067 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3068 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3069 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3070 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3071 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3072 persistence cookie in the cache.
3073 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3074
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003075 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3076 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3077 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3078 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3079 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003080 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003081 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3082 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3083 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3084 they logout.
3085
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003086 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3087 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3088 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3089 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3090
3091 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3092 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3093 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3094 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3095 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3096 this attribute.
3097
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003098 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003099 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003100 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3101 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3102 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3103 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3104 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3105 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003106
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003107 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3108 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3109 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3110 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3111 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3112 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3113 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3114 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003115 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003116 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3117 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3118 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3119 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3120 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3121 the site.
3122
3123 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3124 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3125 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3126 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3127 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3128 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3129 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3130 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3131 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3132 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3133 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3134 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3135 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003136 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003137 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3138 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3139
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003140 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3141 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3142 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3143 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3144 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3145 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3146
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003147 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3148 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3149 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3150 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003151
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003152 Examples :
3153 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3154 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3155 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003156 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003157
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003158 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003159
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003160
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003161declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3162 Declares a capture slot.
3163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3164 no | yes | yes | no
3165 Arguments:
3166 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3167
3168 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3169 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3170 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3171 for use in the response.
3172
3173 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003174 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003175 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3176
3177
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003178default-server [param*]
3179 Change default options for a server in a backend
3180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3181 yes | no | yes | yes
3182 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003183 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3184 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3185 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3186 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003187
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003188 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003189 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3190
3191 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003192
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003193
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003194default_backend <backend>
3195 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3197 yes | yes | yes | no
3198 Arguments :
3199 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3200
3201 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3202 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3203 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3204 will catch all undetermined requests.
3205
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003206 Example :
3207
3208 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3209 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3210 default_backend dynamic
3211
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003212 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003213
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003214
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003215description <string>
3216 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3218 no | yes | yes | yes
3219 Arguments : string
3220
3221 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3222 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3223 it describes.
3224 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3225
3226
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003227disabled
3228 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3230 yes | yes | yes | yes
3231 Arguments : none
3232
3233 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3234 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3235 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3236 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3237 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3238 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3239 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3240
3241 See also : "enabled"
3242
3243
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003244dispatch <address>:<port>
3245 Set a default server address
3246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3247 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003248 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003249
3250 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3251 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3252 during start-up.
3253
3254 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3255 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3256 possible with normal servers.
3257
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003258 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003259 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3260 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3261 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3262 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3263
3264 See also : "server"
3265
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003266
3267dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3268 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3270 yes | no | yes | yes
3271 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3272
3273 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003274 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003275 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3276 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003277 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003278 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003279
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003280enabled
3281 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3283 yes | yes | yes | yes
3284 Arguments : none
3285
3286 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3287 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3288
3289 See also : "disabled"
3290
3291
3292errorfile <code> <file>
3293 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3295 yes | yes | yes | yes
3296 Arguments :
3297 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003298 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3299 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003300
3301 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003302 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003303 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003304 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3305 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003306
3307 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3308 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3309 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3310
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003311 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3312
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003313 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3314 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3315 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3316 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3317
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003318 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3319 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003320 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003321 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3322 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3323 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3324
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003325 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3326 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3327 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003328 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003329 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3330
3331 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3332
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003333 Example :
3334 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003335 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003336 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3337 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3338
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003339
3340errorloc <code> <url>
3341errorloc302 <code> <url>
3342 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3344 yes | yes | yes | yes
3345 Arguments :
3346 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003347 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3348 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003349
3350 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3351 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3352 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3353 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003354 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003355
3356 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3357 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3358 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3359
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003360 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3361
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003362 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3363 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3364 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3365 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003366 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003367 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3368 request.
3369
3370 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3371
3372
3373errorloc303 <code> <url>
3374 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3376 yes | yes | yes | yes
3377 Arguments :
3378 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003379 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3380 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003381
3382 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3383 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3384 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3385 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003386 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003387
3388 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3389 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3390 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3391
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003392 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3393
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003394 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3395 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3396 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3397 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003398 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003399
3400 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3401
3402
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003403email-alert from <emailaddr>
3404 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003405 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003406 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3407 yes | yes | yes | yes
3408
3409 Arguments :
3410
3411 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3412
3413 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3414 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3415
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003416 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003417 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3418 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003419
3420
3421email-alert level <level>
3422 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3423 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3424 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3425 yes | yes | yes | yes
3426
3427 Arguments :
3428
3429 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3430 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3431 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3432
3433 By default level is alert
3434
3435 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3436 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3437 for the proxy.
3438
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003439 Alerts are sent when :
3440
3441 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3442 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3443 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3444 is notice or lower
3445 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3446 and a health check status update occurs
3447
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003448 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3449 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003450 section 3.6 about mailers.
3451
3452
3453email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3454 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3455 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3456 yes | yes | yes | yes
3457
3458 Arguments :
3459
3460 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3461
3462 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3463 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3464
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003465 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3466 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003467
3468
3469email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3470 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3471 mailers.
3472 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3473 yes | yes | yes | yes
3474
3475 Arguments :
3476
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003477 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003478
3479 By default the systems hostname is used.
3480
3481 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3482 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3483 for the proxy.
3484
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003485 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3486 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003487
3488
3489email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003490 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003491 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3492 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3493 yes | yes | yes | yes
3494
3495 Arguments :
3496
3497 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3498
3499 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3500 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3501
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003502 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003503 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3504
3505
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003506force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3507 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3508 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003509 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003510
3511 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3512 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3513 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3514 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3515 marked down for maintenance operations.
3516
3517 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3518 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3519 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3520 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3521 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3522 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3523 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3524 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3525 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3526
3527 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3528 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3529 is used.
3530
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003531 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003532 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003533
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003534
3535filter <name> [param*]
3536 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3538 no | yes | yes | yes
3539 Arguments :
3540 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3541 referenced in section 9.
3542
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003543 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003544 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003545 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3546 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003547
3548 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3549 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3550
3551 Example:
3552 listen
3553 bind *:80
3554
3555 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3556 filter compression
3557 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3558
3559 compression algo gzip
3560 compression offload
3561
3562 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3563
3564 See also : section 9.
3565
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003566
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003567fullconn <conns>
3568 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3570 yes | no | yes | yes
3571 Arguments :
3572 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3573 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3574
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003575 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003576 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003577 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003578 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3579 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3580 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3581 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3582 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003583 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003584
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003585 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3586 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003587 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3588 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3589 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003590
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003591 Example :
3592 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3593 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3594 # connections.
3595 backend dynamic
3596 fullconn 10000
3597 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3598 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3599
3600 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3601
3602
3603grace <time>
3604 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003606 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003607 Arguments :
3608 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3609 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3610 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3611
3612 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3613 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003614 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003615 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3616
3617 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3618 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3619 simplify it.
3620
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003621
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003622hash-balance-factor <factor>
3623 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3625 yes | no | no | yes
3626 Arguments :
3627 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3628 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3629 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3630
3631 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3632 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3633 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3634 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3635 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3636 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3637 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3638
3639 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3640 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3641 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3642 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3643 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3644
3645 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3646
3647
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003648hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003649 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3651 yes | no | yes | yes
3652 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003653 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3654 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003655
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003656 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3657 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3658 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3659 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3660 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3661 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3662 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3663 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3664 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3665 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003666
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003667 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3668 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3669 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3670 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3671 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3672 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3673 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3674 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3675 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3676 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3677 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3678 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3679 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003680 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3681 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003682
3683 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3684
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003685 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003686 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3687 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3688 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003689 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3690 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3691 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003692
3693 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3694 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003695 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3696 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3697 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3698 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3699
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003700 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3701 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3702 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3703 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3704 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3705 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3706 parameter.
3707
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003708 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3709 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3710 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3711 used on strings.
3712
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003713 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3714
3715 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3716 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3717 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3718 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3719 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3720 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3721 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3722 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3723 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3724 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3725 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3726 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003727
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003728 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3729 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3730 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003731
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003732 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003733
3734
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003735http-check disable-on-404
3736 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003738 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003739 Arguments : none
3740
3741 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3742 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3743 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3744 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3745 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3746 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3747 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3748 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003749 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3750 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3751 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3752
3753 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3754
3755
3756http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003757 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003759 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003760 Arguments :
3761 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3762 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003763 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003764 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3765 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3766 details on the supported keywords.
3767
3768 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3769 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3770 with the usual backslash ('\').
3771
3772 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3773 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3774 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3775 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3776 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3777
3778 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003779 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003780 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3781 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3782 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3783
3784 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003785 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003786 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3787 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3788 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3789 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3790
3791 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003792 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003793 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3794 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3795 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3796 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3797 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003798 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003799 trace).
3800
3801 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003802 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003803 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3804 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3805 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3806 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3807 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003808 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003809
3810 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3811 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3812 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3813 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3814 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3815 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3816 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3817 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3818
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003819 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3820 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3821 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3822
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003823 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3824 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3825
3826 Examples :
3827 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003828 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003829
3830 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003831 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003832
3833 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003834 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003835
3836 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003837 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003838
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003839 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003840
3841
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003842http-check send-state
3843 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3845 yes | no | yes | yes
3846 Arguments : none
3847
3848 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3849 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3850 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3851 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3852 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3853
3854 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3855 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3856 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3857 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3858 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003859 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3860 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3861 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3862
3863 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3864 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3865 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3866
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003867 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3868 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3869 checked in multiple backends.
3870
3871 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3872 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3873
3874 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3875 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3876 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3877 one fails.
3878
3879 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3880 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3881 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3882
3883 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3884 server's queue.
3885
3886 Example of a header received by the application server :
3887 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3888 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3889
3890 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3891
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01003892http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> | reject |
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003893 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003894 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003895 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003896 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003897 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3898 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003899 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3900 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003901 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3902 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3903 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003904 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003905 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003906 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003907 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003908 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01003909 sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003910 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003911 silent-drop |
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01003912 send-spoe-group |
3913 cache-use
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003914 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003915 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003916 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3917
3918 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3919 no | yes | yes | yes
3920
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003921 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3922 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3923 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3924 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3925 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003926
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003927 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3928 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3929 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3930
3931 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003932 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3933 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3934 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3935 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003936
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01003937 - "reject" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes
3938 the connection without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
3939 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an
3940 immediate connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
3941
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003942 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3943 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3944 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003945 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3946 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003947 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3948 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3949 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3950 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3951 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003952 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003953 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3954 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003955
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003956 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3957 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3958 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3959 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3960 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3961
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003962 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3963 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3964 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003965 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3966 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003967
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003968 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3969 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3970 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003971 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003972 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3973 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3974 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3975 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3976
3977 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3978 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3979 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003980 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3981 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003982
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003983 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3984 <name>.
3985
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003986 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3987 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3988 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3989 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3990 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3991 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3992 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3993 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3994
3995 Example:
3996
3997 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3998
3999 applied to:
4000
4001 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4002
4003 outputs:
4004
4005 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4006
4007 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
4008
4009 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4010 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4011 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4012 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4013 header.
4014
4015 Example:
4016
4017 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
4018
4019 applied to:
4020
4021 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
4022
4023 outputs:
4024
4025 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
4026
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004027 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
4028 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
4029 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
4030 it.
4031
4032 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
4033 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
4034 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
4035 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
4036 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
4037 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
4038
4039 Example :
4040 # prepend the host name before the path
4041 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
4042
4043 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
4044 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
4045 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
4046 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
4047 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
4048 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
4049 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
4050 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
4051
4052 Example :
4053 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4054 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
4055
4056 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
4057 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
4058 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
4059 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
4060 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
4061 "set-query".
4062
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004063 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4064 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4065 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4066 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4067 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4068 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4069 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4070 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4071
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004072 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4073 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4074 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4075 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4076 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4077 another equipment.
4078
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004079 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4080 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4081 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4082 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4083 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004084 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004085 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4086 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4087
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004088 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4089 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4090 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4091 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4092 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4093 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4094 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4095 admin privileges.
4096
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004097 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4098 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4099 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4100 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4101 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4102 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4103 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4104 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4105
4106 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4107 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4108 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4109 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4110 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4111 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4112
4113 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4114 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4115 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4116 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4117 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4118 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4119
4120 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4121 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4122 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4123 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4124 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4125 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4126 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4127 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4128 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4129
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004130 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004131 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
4132 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4133 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
4134 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
4135 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
4136 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
4137 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
4138 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4139 request header" for more information.
4140
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004141 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
4142 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
4143 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
4144 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004145 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4146 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004147
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004148 - cache-use <name> :
4149 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
4150
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004151 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4152 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
4153 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
4154 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
4155 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
4156 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
4157 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
4158 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
4159 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
4160 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
4161 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
4162 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4163
4164 These actions take one or two arguments :
4165 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
4166 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004167 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004168 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
4169
4170 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
4171 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
4172 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
4173 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
4174
4175 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
4176 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
4177 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
4178 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
4179 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
4180 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
4181 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
4182 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
4183
4184 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
4185 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
4186 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
4187 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
4188 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
4189
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004190 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4191 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4192 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4193 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4194 continues.
4195
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004196 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4197 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4198 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4199 the actions evaluation continues.
4200
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004201 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
4202 Same as "sc-inc-gpc0" action above but for GPC1 counter.
4203
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004204 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
4205 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4206 inline.
4207
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004208 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4209 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004210 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004211 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4212 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004213 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004214 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004215 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004216 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4217 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004218 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004219 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004220 and '_'.
4221
4222 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4223 followed by some converters.
4224
4225 Example:
4226
4227 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
4228
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004229 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4230 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4231
4232 Example:
4233
4234 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4235
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004236 - set-src <expr> :
4237 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4238 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4239 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4240 source IP for privacy.
4241
4242 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4243 followed by some converters.
4244
4245 Example:
4246
4247 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4248 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4249
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004250 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4251 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004252
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004253 - set-src-port <expr> :
4254 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4255 expression.
4256
4257 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4258 followed by some converters.
4259
4260 Example:
4261
4262 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4263 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4264
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004265 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4266 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4267 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004268
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004269 - set-dst <expr> :
4270 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4271 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4272 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4273 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4274 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4275
4276 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4277 followed by some converters.
4278
4279 Example:
4280
4281 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4282 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4283
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004284 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4285 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4286
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004287 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4288 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4289 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4290 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4291
4292 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4293 followed by some converters.
4294
4295 Example:
4296
4297 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4298 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4299
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004300 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4301 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4302 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4303
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004304 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004305 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004306 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4307 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4308 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4309 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4310 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004311 down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact of using
4312 this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the client and
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004313 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4314 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4315 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4316 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4317 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4318 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4319 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4320
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004321
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004322 - "wait-for-handshake" : this will delay the processing of the request
4323 until the SSL handshake happened. This is mostly useful to delay
4324 processing early data until we're sure they are valid.
4325
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004326 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4327 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4328 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4329 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4330 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4331 SPOE agent name must be used.
4332
4333 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4334
4335 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4336 configuration.
4337
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004338 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4339
4340 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4341 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004342 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4343 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4344
4345 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4346 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4347 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4348 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004349
4350 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004351 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4352 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4353 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004354
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004355 http-request allow if nagios
4356 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4357 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4358 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004359
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004360 Example:
4361 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004362 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004363
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004364 Example:
4365 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4366 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004367 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004368 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4369 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4370 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4371 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4372 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4373 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4374
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004375 Example:
4376 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4377 acl add path /addacl
4378 acl del path /delacl
4379
4380 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4381
4382 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4383 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4384
4385 Example:
4386 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4387 acl setmap path /setmap
4388 acl delmap path /delmap
4389
4390 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4391
4392 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4393 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4394
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004395 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4396 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004397
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004398http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004399 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004400 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004401 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4402 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004403 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004404 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4405 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4406 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4407 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004408 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004409 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004410 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004411 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004412 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004413 sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004414 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004415 silent-drop |
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004416 send-spoe-group |
4417 cache-store
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004418 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004419 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004420 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4421
4422 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4423 no | yes | yes | yes
4424
4425 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4426 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4427 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4428 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4429 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4430 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4431
4432 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4433 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4434 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4435 current section.
4436
4437 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4438 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4439 rules are evaluated.
4440
4441 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4442 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4443 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4444 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4445 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4446 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4447 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4448
4449 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4450 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4451 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4452 external users.
4453
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004454 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4455 <name>.
4456
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004457 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4458 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4459 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4460 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4461 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4462 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4463 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4464 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4465
4466 Example:
4467
4468 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4469
4470 applied to:
4471
4472 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4473
4474 outputs:
4475
4476 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4477
4478 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4479
4480 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4481 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4482 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4483 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4484 header.
4485
4486 Example:
4487
4488 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4489
4490 applied to:
4491
4492 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4493
4494 outputs:
4495
4496 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4497
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004498 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004499 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4500 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4501 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004502
4503 Example:
4504
4505 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4506 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004507 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4508 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004509
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004510 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4511 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4512 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4513 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4514 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4515 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4516 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4517 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4518
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004519 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4520 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4521 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4522 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4523 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4524 another equipment.
4525
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004526 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4527 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4528 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4529 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4530 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004531 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004532 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4533 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4534
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004535 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4536 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4537 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4538 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4539 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4540 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4541 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4542 admin privileges.
4543
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004544 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4545 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4546 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4547 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4548 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4549 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4550 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4551 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4552
4553 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4554 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4555 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4556 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4557 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4558 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4559
4560 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4561 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4562 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4563 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4564 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4565 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4566
4567 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4568 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4569 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4570 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4571 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4572 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4573 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4574 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4575 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4576
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004577 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4578 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4579 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4580 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4581 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4582 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4583 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4584 response header" for more information.
4585
4586 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4587 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4588 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4589 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4590 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004591 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4592 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004593
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004594 - cache-store <name> :
4595 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
4596
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004597 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4598 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4599 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4600 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4601 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4602 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4603
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004604 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4605 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4606 inline.
4607
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004608 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4609 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004610 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004611 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4612 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004613 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004614 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004615 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004616 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4617 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004618 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004619 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4620 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004621
4622 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4623 followed by some converters.
4624
4625 Example:
4626
4627 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4628
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004629 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4630 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4631
4632 Example:
4633
4634 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4635
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004636 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4637 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4638 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4639 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004640 use of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4641 Layer 6 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004642 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4643
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004644 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4645 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4646 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4647 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4648 continues.
4649
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004650 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4651 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4652 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4653 the actions evaluation continues.
4654
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004655 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
4656 Same as "sc-inc-gpc0" action above but for GPC1 counter.
4657
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004658 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004659 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004660 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4661 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4662 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4663 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4664 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004665 down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact of using
4666 this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the client and
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004667 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4668 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4669 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4670 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4671 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4672 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4673 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4674
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004675 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4676 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4677 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4678 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4679 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4680 SPOE agent name must be used.
4681
4682 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4683
4684 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4685 configuration.
4686
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004687 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4688
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004689 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004690 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004691 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4692 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004693
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004694 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4695 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4696 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4697 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4698
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004699 Example:
4700 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4701
4702 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4703
4704 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4705 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4706
4707 Example:
4708 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4709
4710 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4711
4712 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4713 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4714
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004715 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4716 ACL usage.
4717
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004718
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004719http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4720 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4721
4722 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4723 yes | no | yes | yes
4724
4725 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4726 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4727 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4728 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4729 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004730 This directive allows to tune this behavior.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004731
4732 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4733
4734 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4735 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4736 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4737 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4738 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4739 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4740 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4741 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4742 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4743 not checking any request past the first one.
4744
4745 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4746 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4747 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4748 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4749 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4750 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4751 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4752
4753 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4754 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4755 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4756 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4757 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4758 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4759 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4760 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4761 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4762 downsides of rare connection failures.
4763
4764 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4765 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4766 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4767 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4768 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4769 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004770 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004771 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4772 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4773 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4774 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4775 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4776
4777 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004778 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
4779 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
4780 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004781
4782 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004783 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004784
4785 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4786 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4787 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004788 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004789
4790 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4791 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4792 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4793
4794 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4795 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4796 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4797
4798 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4799
4800
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004801http-send-name-header [<header>]
4802 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4803
4804 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4805 yes | no | yes | yes
4806
4807 Arguments :
4808
4809 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4810
4811 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004812 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004813 is added with the header string proved.
4814
4815 See also : "server"
4816
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004817id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004818 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4820 no | yes | yes | yes
4821 Arguments : none
4822
4823 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4824 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4825 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004826
4827
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004828ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4829 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4830 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004831 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004832
4833 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4834 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4835 and running).
4836
4837 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4838 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4839 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004840 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004841 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4842
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004843 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4844 "unless" condition is met.
4845
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004846 Example:
4847 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
4848 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
4849 ignore-persist if url_static
4850
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004851 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4852
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004853load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4854 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4855 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4856 yes | no | yes | yes
4857
4858 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4859 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4860 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004861 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004862 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4863 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4864 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4865 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4866
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004867 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004868 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02004869 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004870
4871 Arguments:
4872 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4873 named "server-state-file".
4874
4875 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4876 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4877 name is used as a file name.
4878
4879 none don't load any stat for this backend
4880
4881 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004882 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4883 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4884 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004885 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004886 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004887
4888 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4889 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4890
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004891 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004892
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004893 global
4894 stats socket /tmp/socket
4895 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004896
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004897 defaults
4898 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004899
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004900 backend bk
4901 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4902 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004903
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004904
4905 Then one can run :
4906
4907 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4908
4909 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4910
4911 1
4912 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4913 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4914 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4915
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004916 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004917
4918 global
4919 stats socket /tmp/socket
4920 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4921
4922 defaults
4923 load-server-state-from-file local
4924
4925 backend bk
4926 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4927 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4928
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004929
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004930 Then one can run :
4931
4932 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4933
4934 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4935
4936 1
4937 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4938 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4939 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4940
4941 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4942 "show servers state"
4943
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004944
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004945log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004946log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004947no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004948 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4950 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004951
4952 Prefix :
4953 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4954 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4955 prefix does not allow arguments.
4956
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004957 Arguments :
4958 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4959 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4960 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4961 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4962 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4963 parameter.
4964
4965 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4966 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4967
4968 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4969 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4970 standard syslog port).
4971
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004972 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4973 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4974 standard syslog port).
4975
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004976 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4977 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4978 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004979 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004980
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004981 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4982 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004983
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004984 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4985 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4986 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4987 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4988 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4989 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4990 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4991 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4992 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4993 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004994 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004995
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004996 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4997
4998 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4999 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5000 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5001
5002 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5003 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5004 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005005 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5006 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5007 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5008 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5009 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005010
5011 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5012
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005013 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5014 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5015 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005016
5017 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5018 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5019 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5020 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5021
5022 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5023 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005024
5025 Example :
5026 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005027 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5028 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005029 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005030
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005031
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005032log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005033 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5034 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5035 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005036
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005037 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5038 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5039 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5040 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5041 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005042
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005043 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5044 "option httplog" directives.
5045
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005046log-format-sd <string>
5047 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5048 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5049 yes | yes | yes | no
5050
5051 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5052 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5053 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5054 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5055 which covers the log format string in depth.
5056
5057 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5058 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5059
5060 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5061 log format to "rfc5424".
5062
5063 Example :
5064 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5065
5066
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005067log-tag <string>
5068 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5069 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5070 yes | yes | yes | yes
5071
5072 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5073 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5074 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5075 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5076 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5077 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5078 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5079 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5080 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005081
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005082max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5083 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5084 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5085 yes | no | yes | yes
5086
5087 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5088 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5089 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5090 servers.
5091
5092 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5093 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5094 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5095 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5096 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005097 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005098 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5099 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5100 picking a different server.
5101
5102 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5103 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5104 even if they have to be queued.
5105
5106 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5107 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5108
5109
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005110maxconn <conns>
5111 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5113 yes | yes | yes | no
5114 Arguments :
5115 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5116 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5117 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5118 closes.
5119
5120 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5121 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5122 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5123 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005124 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5125 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5126 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5127 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005128
5129 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5130 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5131 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5132
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005133 By default, this value is set to 2000.
5134
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005135 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5136
5137
5138mode { tcp|http|health }
5139 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5141 yes | yes | yes | yes
5142 Arguments :
5143 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5144 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5145 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5146 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5147
5148 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5149 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5150 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5151 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5152 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5153
5154 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005155 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5156 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5157 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5158 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5159 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5160 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5161 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005162
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005163 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5164 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5165 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005166
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005167 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005168 defaults http_instances
5169 mode http
5170
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005171 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005172
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005173
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005174monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005175 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5177 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005178 Arguments :
5179 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5180 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005181 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005182 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5183 backend and its backup.
5184
5185 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5186 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5187 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5188 servers in a list of backends.
5189
5190 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5191 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5192 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5193 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5194 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5195 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5196 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005197 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5198 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005199
5200 Example:
5201 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005202 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005203 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5204 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5205 monitor-uri /site_alive
5206 monitor fail if site_dead
5207
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005208 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005209
5210
5211monitor-net <source>
5212 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5214 yes | yes | yes | no
5215 Arguments :
5216 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5217 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5218 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5219 followed by a mask.
5220
5221 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5222 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005223 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005224 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5225
5226 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5227 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5228 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5229 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005230 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5231 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5232 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005233
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005234 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5235 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5236 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5237 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5238 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5239 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005240
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005241 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5242 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005243
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005244 Example :
5245 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5246 frontend www
5247 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5248
5249 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5250
5251
5252monitor-uri <uri>
5253 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5255 yes | yes | yes | no
5256 Arguments :
5257 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5258 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5259
5260 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5261 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5262 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5263 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5264 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5265 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5266 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5267 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5268
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005269 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5270 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5271 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5272 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5273 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5274 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5275 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5276 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005277
5278 Example :
5279 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5280 frontend www
5281 mode http
5282 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5283
5284 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5285
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005286
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005287option abortonclose
5288no option abortonclose
5289 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5291 yes | no | yes | yes
5292 Arguments : none
5293
5294 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5295 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5296 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5297 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005298 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005299 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5300 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5301 encountered while delivering the response.
5302
5303 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5304 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5305 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5306 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5307 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5308 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005309 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005310 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005311 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005312 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5313 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5314 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5315
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005316 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5317 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005318 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5319 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5320 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5321 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5322 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5323 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005324 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005325
5326 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5327 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5328
5329 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5330
5331
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005332option accept-invalid-http-request
5333no option accept-invalid-http-request
5334 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5336 yes | yes | yes | no
5337 Arguments : none
5338
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005339 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005340 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005341 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005342 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5343 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5344 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5345 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5346 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005347 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5348 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5349 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5350 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005351 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005352 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005353 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5354 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5355 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005356
5357 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5358 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5359 been confirmed.
5360
5361 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5362 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005363 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5364 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005365 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5366
5367 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5368 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5369
5370 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5371 stats socket.
5372
5373
5374option accept-invalid-http-response
5375no option accept-invalid-http-response
5376 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5378 yes | no | yes | yes
5379 Arguments : none
5380
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005381 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005382 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005383 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005384 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5385 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5386 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5387 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5388 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005389 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5390 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5391 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005392
5393 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5394 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5395 been confirmed.
5396
5397 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5398 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5399 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5400 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5401
5402 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5403 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5404
5405 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5406 stats socket.
5407
5408
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005409option allbackups
5410no option allbackups
5411 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5413 yes | no | yes | yes
5414 Arguments : none
5415
5416 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5417 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5418 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5419 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5420 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5421 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5422 order between the backup servers anymore.
5423
5424 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5425 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5426
5427 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5428 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5429
5430
5431option checkcache
5432no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005433 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5435 yes | no | yes | yes
5436 Arguments : none
5437
5438 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5439 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005440 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005441 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5442 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005443 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005444
5445 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005446 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005447 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005448 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5449 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005450 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005451 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005452 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5453 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005454 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005455 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5456 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005457 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005458 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5459 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5460 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5461 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5462 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5463 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5464 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5465 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5466 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5467
5468 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005469 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005470 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005471 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005472 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5473
5474 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5475 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005476 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005477 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005478
5479 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5480 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5481
5482
5483option clitcpka
5484no option clitcpka
5485 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5487 yes | yes | yes | no
5488 Arguments : none
5489
5490 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5491 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005492 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005493 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5494
5495 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5496 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5497 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5498 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5499
5500 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5501 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5502 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5503 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5504 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5505
5506 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5507
5508 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5509 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5510 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5511
5512 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5513 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5514
5515 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5516
5517
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005518option contstats
5519 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5521 yes | yes | yes | no
5522 Arguments : none
5523
5524 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5525 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5526 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5527 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005528 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5529 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5530 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5531 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5532 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005533
5534
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005535option dontlog-normal
5536no option dontlog-normal
5537 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5539 yes | yes | yes | no
5540 Arguments : none
5541
5542 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5543 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5544 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5545 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5546 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5547 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5548 logged.
5549
5550 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5551 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5552 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5553
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005554 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005555 logging.
5556
5557
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005558option dontlognull
5559no option dontlognull
5560 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5562 yes | yes | yes | no
5563 Arguments : none
5564
5565 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5566 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5567 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5568 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5569 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5570 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005571 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5572 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5573 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005574
5575 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005576 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005577 would not be logged.
5578
5579 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5580 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5581
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005582 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5583 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005584
5585
5586option forceclose
5587no option forceclose
5588 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005590 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005591 Arguments : none
5592
5593 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5594 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5595 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5596 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5597 global session times in the logs.
5598
5599 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005600 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005601 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005602
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005603 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5604 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5605 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5606
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005607 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5608 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005609
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005610 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5611 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5612
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005613 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005614
5615
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005616option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005617 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5619 yes | yes | yes | yes
5620 Arguments :
5621 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5622 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005623 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005624 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005625
5626 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5627 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5628 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5629 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5630 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5631 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5632 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005633 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5634 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5635 possible that the client has already brought one.
5636
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005637 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005638 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005639 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005640 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005641 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005642 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005643
5644 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5645 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5646 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5647 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5648 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5649 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5650 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5651
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005652 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5653 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5654 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5655 are under the control of the end-user.
5656
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005657 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005658 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5659 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005660 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5661 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5662 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005663
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005664 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005665 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5666 frontend www
5667 mode http
5668 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5669
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005670 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5671 backend www
5672 mode http
5673 option forwardfor header X-Client
5674
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005675 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005676 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005677
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005678
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005679option http-buffer-request
5680no option http-buffer-request
5681 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5683 yes | yes | yes | yes
5684 Arguments : none
5685
5686 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5687 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5688 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5689 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5690 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5691 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5692 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5693 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005694 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005695 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5696 default.
5697
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005698 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005699
5700
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005701option http-ignore-probes
5702no option http-ignore-probes
5703 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5705 yes | yes | yes | no
5706 Arguments : none
5707
5708 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5709 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5710 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5711 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5712 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5713 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5714 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5715 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5716 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005717 was received over a connection before it was closed;
5718 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005719 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5720
5721 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5722 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5723 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5724 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5725 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5726 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5727 are often the only way to detect them.
5728
5729 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5730 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5731
5732 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5733
5734
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005735option http-keep-alive
5736no option http-keep-alive
5737 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5739 yes | yes | yes | yes
5740 Arguments : none
5741
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005742 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5743 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5744 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5745 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5746 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5747 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5748 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5749
5750 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5751 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005752 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5753 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5754 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5755 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5756 situations where this option may be useful :
5757
5758 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005759 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005760
5761 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5762 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5763
5764 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5765 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5766 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5767 request.
5768
5769 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5770 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005771 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5772 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5773 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005774
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005775 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5776 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5777 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5778 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5779 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5780 not set.
5781
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005782 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5783 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005784 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005785 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005786
5787 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005788 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5789 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005790
5791
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005792option http-no-delay
5793no option http-no-delay
5794 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5796 yes | yes | yes | yes
5797 Arguments : none
5798
5799 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5800 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5801 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5802 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5803 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5804 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5805 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5806 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5807 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5808 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5809 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5810 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5811 affected.
5812
5813 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5814 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5815 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5816 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5817 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5818 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5819 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5820 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5821 latency environments.
5822
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005823 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5824
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005825
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005826option http-pretend-keepalive
5827no option http-pretend-keepalive
5828 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5830 yes | yes | yes | yes
5831 Arguments : none
5832
5833 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5834 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5835 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5836 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5837 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5838 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5839 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5840 consider the response complete.
5841
5842 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5843 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5844 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5845 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5846 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5847 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5848
5849 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5850 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5851 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5852 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5853 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5854 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5855 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5856
5857 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5858 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005859 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005860 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5861 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005862
5863 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5864 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5865
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005866 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5867 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005868
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005869
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005870option http-server-close
5871no option http-server-close
5872 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5874 yes | yes | yes | yes
5875 Arguments : none
5876
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005877 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5878 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5879 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5880 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5881 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5882 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5883 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005884 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005885 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5886 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5887 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005888 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005889 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5890 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5891 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5892 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005893
5894 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5895 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5896 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5897 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005898 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5899 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005900
5901 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5902 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005903 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5904 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005905 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5906 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005907
5908 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5909 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5910
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005911 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005912 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5913 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005914
5915
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005916option http-tunnel
5917no option http-tunnel
5918 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5920 yes | yes | yes | yes
5921 Arguments : none
5922
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005923 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5924 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5925 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5926 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5927 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5928 "option http-tunnel".
5929
5930 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005931 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005932 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5933 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5934 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5935 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5936 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5937 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5938 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005939
5940 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5941 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5942
5943 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5944 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5945 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5946
5947
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005948option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005949no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005950 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5952 yes | yes | yes | no
5953 Arguments : none
5954
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005955 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005956 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5957 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5958 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5959 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5960 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5961 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5962
5963 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5964 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005965 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5966 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5967 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005968
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005969 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5970 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5971 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5972 front of an existing proxy.
5973
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005974 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5975
5976 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5977 http-server-close".
5978
5979
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005980option httpchk
5981option httpchk <uri>
5982option httpchk <method> <uri>
5983option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5984 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5986 yes | no | yes | yes
5987 Arguments :
5988 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5989 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5990 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5991 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5992 ones.
5993
5994 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5995 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5996 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5997
5998 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5999 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6000 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6001 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6002 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6003
6004 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6005 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6006 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6007 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6008 the lack of any response.
6009
6010 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6011
6012 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6013 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6014 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6015
6016 Examples :
6017 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6018 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6019 backend https_relay
6020 mode tcp
6021 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6022 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6023
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006024 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6025 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6026 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006027
6028
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006029option httpclose
6030no option httpclose
6031 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
6032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6033 yes | yes | yes | yes
6034 Arguments : none
6035
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006036 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6037 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6038 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6039 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006040 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006041 "option http-tunnel".
6042
6043 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
6044 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
6045 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
6046 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
6047 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
6048 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
6049 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
6050 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006051
6052 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006053 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01006054 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
6055 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
6056 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
6057 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
6058 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006059
6060 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6061 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006062 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
6063 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006064 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
6065 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006066
6067 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6068 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6069
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02006070 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
6071 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006072
6073
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006074option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006075 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006077 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006078 Arguments :
6079 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6080 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6081 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006082 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006083 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006084
6085 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6086 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6087 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6088 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6089 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6090 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6091 ports.
6092
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006093 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6094 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006095
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006096 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6097
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006098 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006099
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006100
6101option http_proxy
6102no option http_proxy
6103 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6105 yes | yes | yes | yes
6106 Arguments : none
6107
6108 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6109 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6110 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6111 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6112 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6113
6114 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6115 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006116 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6117 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006118
6119 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6120 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6121
6122 Example :
6123 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6124 backend direct_forward
6125 option httpclose
6126 option http_proxy
6127
6128 See also : "option httpclose"
6129
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006130
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006131option independent-streams
6132no option independent-streams
6133 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6135 yes | yes | yes | yes
6136 Arguments : none
6137
6138 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6139 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6140 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6141 receive data or not.
6142
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006143 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006144 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6145 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6146 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6147 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6148 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6149 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6150 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6151 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6152 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6153 socket buffers.
6154
6155 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6156 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6157 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6158 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6159 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6160
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006161 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006162 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6163 deprecated.
6164
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006165 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006166
6167
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006168option ldap-check
6169 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6171 yes | no | yes | yes
6172 Arguments : none
6173
6174 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6175 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6176 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6177 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6178
6179 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6180 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6181
6182 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6183 configure it.
6184
6185 Example :
6186 option ldap-check
6187
6188 See also : "option httpchk"
6189
6190
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006191option external-check
6192 Use external processes for server health checks
6193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6194 yes | no | yes | yes
6195
6196 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6197 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6198 command".
6199
6200 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6201
6202 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6203
6204
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006205option log-health-checks
6206no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006207 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6209 yes | no | yes | yes
6210 Arguments : none
6211
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006212 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6213 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6214 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006215
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006216 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6217 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6218 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6219 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6220 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6221
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006222 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006223 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006224
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006225 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6226 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6227 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006228
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006229
6230option log-separate-errors
6231no option log-separate-errors
6232 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6234 yes | yes | yes | no
6235 Arguments : none
6236
6237 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6238 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6239 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6240 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6241 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6242 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6243 provides very important information.
6244
6245 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6246 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6247 error logs.
6248
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006249 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006250 logging.
6251
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006252
6253option logasap
6254no option logasap
6255 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6257 yes | yes | yes | no
6258 Arguments : none
6259
6260 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6261 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6262 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6263 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6264 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6265 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6266 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006267 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006268 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6269 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6270
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006271 Examples :
6272 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6273 mode http
6274 option httplog
6275 option logasap
6276 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6277
6278 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6279 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6280 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6281 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6282
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006283 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006284 logging.
6285
6286
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006287option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006288 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6290 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006291 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006292 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6293 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006294 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006295
6296 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6297 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006298 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006299 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6300 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6301 in the MySQL table, like this :
6302
6303 USE mysql;
6304 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6305 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6306
6307 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006308 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006309 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6310 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6311 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6312 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6313 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6314 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6315 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6316
6317 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6318 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006319
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006320 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006321
6322 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6323 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6324 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6325 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006326 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6327 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006328
6329 See also: "option httpchk"
6330
6331
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006332option nolinger
6333no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006334 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006335 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6336 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006337 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006338
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006339 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006340 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6341 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6342 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6343 connections.
6344
6345 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6346 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6347 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6348 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6349 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6350 this too.
6351
6352 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6353 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6354 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6355
6356 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6357 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6358 for servers.
6359
6360 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6361 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6362
6363
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006364option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6365 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6367 yes | yes | yes | yes
6368 Arguments :
6369 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6370 matching <network>
6371 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6372 header name.
6373
6374 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6375 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6376 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6377 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6378 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6379 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6380 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6381 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6382 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6383 possible that the client has already brought one.
6384
6385 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6386 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6387 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6388 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6389 header and requires different one.
6390
6391 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6392 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6393 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6394 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6395 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6396 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6397 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6398
6399 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6400 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6401 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6402 both are defined.
6403
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006404 Examples :
6405 # Original Destination address
6406 frontend www
6407 mode http
6408 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6409
6410 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6411 backend www
6412 mode http
6413 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6414
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006415 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6416 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006417
6418
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006419option persist
6420no option persist
6421 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6422 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6423 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006424 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006425
6426 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6427 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6428 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6429 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6430 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6431 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6432 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6433 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6434 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6435 redirected to another valid server.
6436
6437 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6438 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6439
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006440 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006441
6442
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006443option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6444 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6446 yes | no | yes | yes
6447 Arguments :
6448 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6449 PostgreSQL server.
6450
6451 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6452 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6453 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6454 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6455
6456 See also: "option httpchk"
6457
6458
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006459option prefer-last-server
6460no option prefer-last-server
6461 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6462 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6463 yes | no | yes | yes
6464 Arguments : none
6465
6466 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6467 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6468 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6469 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6470 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6471 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6472 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6473 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6474 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006475 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6476 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6477 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6478 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6479 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6480 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6481 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006482
6483 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6484 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6485
6486 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6487
6488
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006489option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006490option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006491no option redispatch
6492 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6493 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6494 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006495 Arguments :
6496 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6497 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6498 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006499 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006500 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006501 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006502 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6503 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6504 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6505
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006506
6507 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6508 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6509 be able to access the service anymore.
6510
6511 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6512 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6513
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006514 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006515 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6516 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006517
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006518 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6519 "redisp" keywords.
6520
6521 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6522 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6523
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006524 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006525
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006526
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006527option redis-check
6528 Use redis health checks for server testing
6529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6530 yes | no | yes | yes
6531 Arguments : none
6532
6533 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6534 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6535 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6536 find the "+PONG" response message.
6537
6538 Example :
6539 option redis-check
6540
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006541 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006542
6543
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006544option smtpchk
6545option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6546 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6548 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006549 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006550 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6551 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6552 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6553
6554 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6555 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6556 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6557
6558 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6559 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6560 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6561 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6562 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6563 dead server.
6564
6565 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6566 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006567 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006568 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6569
6570 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6571 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6572 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6573 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006574 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006575
6576 Example :
6577 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6578
6579 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006581
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006582option socket-stats
6583no option socket-stats
6584
6585 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6587 yes | yes | yes | no
6588
6589 Arguments : none
6590
6591
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006592option splice-auto
6593no option splice-auto
6594 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6596 yes | yes | yes | yes
6597 Arguments : none
6598
6599 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6600 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006601 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006602 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006603 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006604 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6605 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6606 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6607 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6608
6609 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6610 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6611 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6612 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6613 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6614 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6615 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6616 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6617 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6618 keyword.
6619
6620 Example :
6621 option splice-auto
6622
6623 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6624 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6625
6626 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6627 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6628
6629
6630option splice-request
6631no option splice-request
6632 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6634 yes | yes | yes | yes
6635 Arguments : none
6636
6637 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006638 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006639 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6640 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6641 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6642 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6643
6644 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6645
6646 Example :
6647 option splice-request
6648
6649 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6650 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6651
6652 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6653 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6654
6655
6656option splice-response
6657no option splice-response
6658 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6660 yes | yes | yes | yes
6661 Arguments : none
6662
6663 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006664 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006665 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6666 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6667 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6668 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6669
6670 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6671
6672 Example :
6673 option splice-response
6674
6675 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6676 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6677
6678 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6679 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6680
6681
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006682option spop-check
6683 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6685 no | no | no | yes
6686 Arguments : none
6687
6688 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6689 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6690 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6691 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6692
6693 Example :
6694 option spop-check
6695
6696 See also : "option httpchk"
6697
6698
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006699option srvtcpka
6700no option srvtcpka
6701 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6703 yes | no | yes | yes
6704 Arguments : none
6705
6706 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6707 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006708 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006709 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6710
6711 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6712 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6713 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6714 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6715
6716 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6717 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6718 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6719 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6720 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6721
6722 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6723
6724 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6725 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6726 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6727
6728 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6729 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6730
6731 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6732
6733
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006734option ssl-hello-chk
6735 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6737 yes | no | yes | yes
6738 Arguments : none
6739
6740 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6741 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6742 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6743 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6744 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6745 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6746 hello message.
6747
6748 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6749 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6750 messages, which is appreciable.
6751
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006752 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6753 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6754 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006755
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006756 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6757
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006758
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006759option tcp-check
6760 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6761 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6762 yes | no | yes | yes
6763
6764 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6765 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6766
6767 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6768 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6769 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6770
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006771 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006772 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6773 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6774 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6775 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6776 only.
6777
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006778 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006779 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6780 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6781 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6782 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6783
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006784 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006785 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
6786 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006787 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006788 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6789 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6790 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6791 the respective protocols.
6792 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006793 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006794
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006795 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6796 script.
6797
6798 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6799 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6800 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6801 The "comment" is of course optional.
6802
6803
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006804 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006805 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006806 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006807 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006808
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006809 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006810 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006811 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006812
6813 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6814 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006815 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006816 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006817 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006818 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006819 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006820 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006821 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6822 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006823 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006824 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6825 tcp-check expect string +OK
6826
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006827 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006828 (send many headers before analyzing)
6829 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006830 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006831 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6832 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6833 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6834 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006835 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006836
6837
6838 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6839
6840
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006841option tcp-smart-accept
6842no option tcp-smart-accept
6843 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6845 yes | yes | yes | no
6846 Arguments : none
6847
6848 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6849 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6850 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6851 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6852 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6853 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6854
6855 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6856 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6857 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6858 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6859
6860 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6861 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6862 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006863 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006864
6865 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6866 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6867 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6868
6869 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6870 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6871 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6872
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006873 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6874
6875
6876option tcp-smart-connect
6877no option tcp-smart-connect
6878 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6880 yes | no | yes | yes
6881 Arguments : none
6882
6883 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6884 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6885 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6886 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6887 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6888
6889 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6890 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6891 complex.
6892
6893 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6894 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6895 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6896
6897 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6898 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6899
6900 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6901
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006902
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006903option tcpka
6904 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6906 yes | yes | yes | yes
6907 Arguments : none
6908
6909 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6910 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006911 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006912 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6913
6914 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6915 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6916 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6917 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6918
6919 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6920 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6921 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6922 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6923 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6924
6925 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6926
6927 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6928 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6929 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6930 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6931 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6932 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6933 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6934 backends.
6935
6936 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6937
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006938
6939option tcplog
6940 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006942 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006943 Arguments : none
6944
6945 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6946 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6947 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6948 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6949 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6950 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6951 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6952 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6953
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006954 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006956 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006957
6958
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006959option transparent
6960no option transparent
6961 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006963 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006964 Arguments : none
6965
6966 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6967 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6968 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6969 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6970 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6971 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6972 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6973 appropriate server.
6974
6975 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6976 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6977
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006978 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006979 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006980
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006981
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006982external-check command <command>
6983 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6985 yes | no | yes | yes
6986
6987 Arguments :
6988 <command> is the external command to run
6989
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006990 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6991
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006992 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006993
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006994 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6995 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6996 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6997 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6998 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6999 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007000
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007001 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7002
7003 Environment variables :
7004 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7005 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7006
7007 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7008
7009 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7010
7011 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7012 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7013 for a UNIX socket).
7014
7015 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7016
7017 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7018
7019 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7020
7021 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7022
7023 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7024
7025 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7026 socket).
7027
7028 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7029 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7030
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007031 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7032 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7033 failed.
7034
7035 Example :
7036 external-check command /bin/true
7037
7038 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7039
7040
7041external-check path <path>
7042 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7044 yes | no | yes | yes
7045
7046 Arguments :
7047 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7048
7049 The default path is "".
7050
7051 Example :
7052 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7053
7054 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7055 "external-check command"
7056
7057
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007058persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007059persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007060 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7062 yes | no | yes | yes
7063 Arguments :
7064 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007065 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7066 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007067
7068 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7069 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007070 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007071 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7072 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7073 forwarded to this server.
7074
7075 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7076 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7077 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007078 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007079 a single "listen" section.
7080
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007081 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7082 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7083 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7084
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007085 Example :
7086 listen tse-farm
7087 bind :3389
7088 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7089 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7090 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7091 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7092 persist rdp-cookie
7093 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007094 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007095 balance rdp-cookie
7096 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7097 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7098
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007099 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7100 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007101
7102
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007103rate-limit sessions <rate>
7104 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7106 yes | yes | yes | no
7107 Arguments :
7108 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7109 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7110
7111 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7112 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7113 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7114 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7115 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7116 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7117
7118 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7119 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7120 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7121 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7122
7123 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7124 listen smtp
7125 mode tcp
7126 bind :25
7127 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007128 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007129
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007130 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7131 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7132 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007133
7134 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7135
7136
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007137redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7138redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7139redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007140 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7142 no | yes | yes | yes
7143
7144 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007145 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007146
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007147 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007148 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007149 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7150 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7151 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007152
7153 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7154 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7155 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7156 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7157 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007158 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7159 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7160 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7161 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007162
7163 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7164 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7165 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7166 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7167 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7168 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007169 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007170 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007171 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7172 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7173 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007174
7175 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007176 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7177 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7178 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007179 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007180 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7181 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7182 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7183 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007184
7185 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007186 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007187
7188 - "drop-query"
7189 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7190 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7191 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7192 with a location-type redirect.
7193
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007194 - "append-slash"
7195 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7196 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7197 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7198 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7199
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007200 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7201 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7202 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7203 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7204 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7205 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7206 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7207
7208 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7209 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7210 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7211 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7212 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7213 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7214 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007215
7216 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7217 acl clear dst_port 80
7218 acl secure dst_port 8080
7219 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007220 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007221 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007222 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7223
7224 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007225 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7226 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7227 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007228 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007229
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007230 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7231 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7232 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7233
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007234 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007235 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007236
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007237 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007238 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7239 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7240 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007241
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007242 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007243
7244
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007245redisp (deprecated)
7246redispatch (deprecated)
7247 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7248 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7249 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007250 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007251
7252 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7253 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7254 be able to access the service anymore.
7255
7256 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7257 redistribute them to a working server.
7258
7259 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7260 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7261 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007262
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007263 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7264 "option redispatch" instead.
7265
7266 See also : "option redispatch"
7267
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007268
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007269reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007270 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7272 no | yes | yes | yes
7273 Arguments :
7274 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7275 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007276 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007277
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007278 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7279 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7280
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007281 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7282 the last header of an HTTP request.
7283
7284 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7285 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7286 responses.
7287
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007288 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7289 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7290 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7291
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007292 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7293 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007294
7295
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007296reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7297reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007298 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7300 no | yes | yes | yes
7301 Arguments :
7302 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7303 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7304 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7305 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7306 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7307 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7308 ignores case.
7309
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007310 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7311 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7312
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007313 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7314 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7315 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7316 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007317 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007318
7319 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7320 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7321
7322 Example :
7323 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7324 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7325 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7326
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007327 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7328 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007329
7330
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007331reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7332reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007333 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7335 no | yes | yes | yes
7336 Arguments :
7337 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7338 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7339 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7340 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7341 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7342 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7343
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007344 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7345 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7346
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007347 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7348 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7349 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7350 next servers.
7351
7352 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7353 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7354 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7355
7356 Example :
7357 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7358 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7359 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7360
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007361 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7362 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007363
7364
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007365reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7366reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007367 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7369 no | yes | yes | yes
7370 Arguments :
7371 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7372 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7373 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7374 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7375 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7376 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7377 case.
7378
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007379 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7380 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7381
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007382 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7383 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7384 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7385 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007386 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007387
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007388 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007389 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007390 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007391
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007392 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7393 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7394
7395 Example :
7396 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7397 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7398 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7399
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007400 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7401 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007402
7403
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007404reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7405reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007406 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7408 no | yes | yes | yes
7409 Arguments :
7410 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7411 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7412 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7413 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7414 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7415 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7416 case.
7417
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007418 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7419 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7420
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007421 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7422 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7423 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7424 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7425
7426 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7427 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7428
7429 Example :
7430 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7431 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7432 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7433 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7434
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007435 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7436 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007437
7438
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007439reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7440reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007441 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7443 no | yes | yes | yes
7444 Arguments :
7445 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7446 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7447 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7448 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7449 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7450 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7451
7452 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7453 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7454 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7455 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007456 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007457
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007458 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7459 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7460
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007461 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7462 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7463 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7464
7465 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7466 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7467 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7468 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7469 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7470
7471 Example :
7472 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007473 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007474 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7475 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7476
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007477 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7478 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007479
7480
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007481reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7482reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007483 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7485 no | yes | yes | yes
7486 Arguments :
7487 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7488 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7489 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7490 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7491 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7492 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7493 ignores case.
7494
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007495 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7496 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7497
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007498 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7499 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007500 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7501 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7502 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007503 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7504 not set.
7505
7506 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7507 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7508 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7509 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7510 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7511
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007512 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007513 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007514 # block all others.
7515 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7516 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7517
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007518 # block bad guys
7519 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7520 reqitarpit . if badguys
7521
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007522 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7523 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007524
7525
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007526retries <value>
7527 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7528 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7529 yes | no | yes | yes
7530 Arguments :
7531 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7532 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7533 default value is 3.
7534
7535 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7536 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7537 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7538
7539 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007540 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7541 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007542
7543 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7544 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7545
7546 See also : "option redispatch"
7547
7548
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007549rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007550 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7552 no | yes | yes | yes
7553 Arguments :
7554 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7555 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007556 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007557
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007558 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7559 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7560
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007561 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7562 the last header of an HTTP response.
7563
7564 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7565 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7566 responses.
7567
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007568 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7569 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007570
7571
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007572rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7573rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007574 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7576 no | yes | yes | yes
7577 Arguments :
7578 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7579 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7580 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7581 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7582 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7583 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7584 ignores case.
7585
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007586 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7587 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7588
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007589 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7590 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007591 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007592 client.
7593
7594 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7595 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7596 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7597
7598 Example :
7599 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007600 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007601
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007602 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7603 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007604
7605
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007606rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7607rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007608 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7610 no | yes | yes | yes
7611 Arguments :
7612 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7613 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7614 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7615 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7616 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7617 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7618 ignores case.
7619
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007620 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7621 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7622
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007623 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7624 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7625 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7626 case-sensitive.
7627
7628 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007629 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7630 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7631 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007632
7633 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7634 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7635
7636 Example :
7637 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7638 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7639
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007640 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7641 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007642
7643
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007644rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7645rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007646 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7648 no | yes | yes | yes
7649 Arguments :
7650 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7651 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7652 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7653 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7654 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7655 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7656 ignores case.
7657
7658 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7659 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7660 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7661 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007662 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007663
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007664 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7665 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7666
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007667 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7668 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7669 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7670
7671 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7672 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7673 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7674 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7675 are not case-sensitive.
7676
7677 Example :
7678 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7679 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7680
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007681 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7682 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007683
7684
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007685server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007686 Declare a server in a backend
7687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7688 no | no | yes | yes
7689 Arguments :
7690 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007691 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007692 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007693
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007694 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7695 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7696 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7697 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007698 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7699 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7700 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7701 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7702 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007703 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7704 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7705 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7706 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7707 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7708 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7709 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007710 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007711 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7712 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007713 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7714 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007715
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007716 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007717 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7718 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7719 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7720 adding this value to the client's port.
7721
7722 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7723 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007724 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007725
7726 Examples :
7727 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7728 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007729 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007730 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7731 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7732 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007733
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007734 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7735 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7736 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7737 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7738 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7739
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007740 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7741 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007742
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007743server-state-file-name [<file>]
7744 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7745 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7746 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7747 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7748 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7749 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7750
7751 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7752 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7753
7754 global
7755 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7756
7757 backend bk
7758 load-server-state-from-file
7759
7760 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7761 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007762
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007763server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7764 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7765 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7767 no | no | yes | yes
7768
7769 Arguments:
7770 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7771
7772 <num | range>
7773 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7774 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7775 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7776 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7777
7778 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7779
7780 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7781
7782 <params*>
7783 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7784 keyword.
7785
7786 Examples:
7787 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7788 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7789 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7790
7791 # or
7792 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7793
7794 # would be equivalent to:
7795 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7796 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7797 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7798
7799
7800
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007801source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007802source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007803source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007804 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7806 yes | no | yes | yes
7807 Arguments :
7808 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7809 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007810
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007811 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007812 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7813 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7814 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7815 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7816 supported prefixes are :
7817 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7818 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7819 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007820 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007821 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7822 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007823
7824 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7825 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007826 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7827 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7828 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007829
7830 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7831 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7832 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7833 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7834 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7835 <addr>.
7836
7837 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7838 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7839 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7840 port.
7841
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007842 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7843 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7844 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7845 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007846 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007847 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7848 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7849 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7850 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7851 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7852 HTTP header.
7853
7854 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7855 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007856 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007857 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7858 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7859 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7860 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7861 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7862 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7863 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7864
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007865 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7866 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7867 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7868 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7869 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7870 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7871
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007872 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7873 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7874 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7875 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7876
7877 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7878 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7879 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7880 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7881 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7882 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7883
7884 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7885 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7886 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7887 there are two methods :
7888
7889 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7890 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7891 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7892 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7893 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7894 of the client ranges may be used.
7895
7896 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7897 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7898 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7899 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7900 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7901 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7902 same session.
7903
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007904 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7905 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7906 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007907 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007908
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007909 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7910
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007911 Examples :
7912 backend private
7913 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7914 source 192.168.1.200
7915
7916 backend transparent_ssl1
7917 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7918 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7919
7920 backend transparent_ssl2
7921 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7922 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7923 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7924
7925 backend transparent_ssl3
7926 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7927 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7928 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7929
7930 backend transparent_smtp
7931 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7932 # with Tproxy version 4.
7933 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7934
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007935 backend transparent_http
7936 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7937 # proxy.
7938 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7939
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007940 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007941 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7942
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007943
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007944srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7945 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7947 yes | no | yes | yes
7948 Arguments :
7949 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7950 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7951 as explained at the top of this document.
7952
7953 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7954 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7955 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7956 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7957 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7958 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7959 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7960
7961 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7962 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7963 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7964 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7965 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007966 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007967 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007968 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007969
7970 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7971 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7972 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7973 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7974 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7975 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7976
7977 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7978 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7979
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007980 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7981 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007982
7983
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007984stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7985 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007987 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007988
7989 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7990 matched.
7991
7992 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7993 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7994
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007995 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7996 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007997 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007998
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007999 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8000 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8001 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8002 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008003
8004 Example :
8005 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8006 backend stats_localhost
8007 stats enable
8008 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8009
8010 Example :
8011 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8012 backend stats_auth
8013 stats enable
8014 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8015 stats admin if TRUE
8016
8017 Example :
8018 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8019 userlist stats-auth
8020 group admin users admin
8021 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8022 group readonly users haproxy
8023 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8024
8025 backend stats_auth
8026 stats enable
8027 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8028 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8029 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8030 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8031
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008032 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8033 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8034 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008035
8036
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008037stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8038 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008040 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008041 Arguments :
8042 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8043
8044 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8045
8046 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8047 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8048 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8049 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8050 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8051 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8052
8053 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8054 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8055 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008056 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008057
8058 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8059 report using "stats scope".
8060
8061 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8062 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8063 unobvious parameters.
8064
8065 Example :
8066 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8067 backend public_www
8068 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8069 stats enable
8070 stats hide-version
8071 stats scope .
8072 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008073 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008074 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8075 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8076
8077 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8078 backend private_monitoring
8079 stats enable
8080 stats uri /admin?stats
8081 stats refresh 5s
8082
8083 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8084
8085
8086stats enable
8087 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008089 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008090 Arguments : none
8091
8092 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8093 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8094 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8095 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8096 - stats auth : no authentication
8097 - stats scope : no restriction
8098
8099 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8100 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8101 unobvious parameters.
8102
8103 Example :
8104 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8105 backend public_www
8106 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8107 stats enable
8108 stats hide-version
8109 stats scope .
8110 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008111 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008112 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8113 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8114
8115 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8116 backend private_monitoring
8117 stats enable
8118 stats uri /admin?stats
8119 stats refresh 5s
8120
8121 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8122
8123
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008124stats hide-version
8125 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008127 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008128 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008129
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008130 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8131 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8132 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8133 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8134 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8135 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008136
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008137 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8138 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8139 unobvious parameters.
8140
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008141 Example :
8142 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8143 backend public_www
8144 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008145 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008146 stats hide-version
8147 stats scope .
8148 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008149 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008150 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8151 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008152
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008153 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8154 backend private_monitoring
8155 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008156 stats uri /admin?stats
8157 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008158
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008159 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008160
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008161
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008162stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8163 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8164 Access control for statistics
8165
8166 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8167 no | no | yes | yes
8168
8169 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8170 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8171 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8172 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8173 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8174 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8175
8176 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8177 instance.
8178
8179 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8180 about ACL usage.
8181
8182
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008183stats realm <realm>
8184 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008186 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008187 Arguments :
8188 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8189 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8190 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8191
8192 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8193 using a backslash ('\').
8194
8195 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8196 only related to authentication.
8197
8198 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8199 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8200 unobvious parameters.
8201
8202 Example :
8203 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8204 backend public_www
8205 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8206 stats enable
8207 stats hide-version
8208 stats scope .
8209 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008210 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008211 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8212 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8213
8214 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8215 backend private_monitoring
8216 stats enable
8217 stats uri /admin?stats
8218 stats refresh 5s
8219
8220 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8221
8222
8223stats refresh <delay>
8224 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008226 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008227 Arguments :
8228 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8229 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8230 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8231 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8232 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8233 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8234
8235 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8236 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8237 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8238 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8239
8240 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8241 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8242 unobvious parameters.
8243
8244 Example :
8245 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8246 backend public_www
8247 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8248 stats enable
8249 stats hide-version
8250 stats scope .
8251 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008252 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008253 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8254 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8255
8256 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8257 backend private_monitoring
8258 stats enable
8259 stats uri /admin?stats
8260 stats refresh 5s
8261
8262 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8263
8264
8265stats scope { <name> | "." }
8266 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008268 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008269 Arguments :
8270 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8271 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8272 section in which the statement appears.
8273
8274 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8275 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8276 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8277 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8278 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8279 exists.
8280
8281 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8282 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8283 unobvious parameters.
8284
8285 Example :
8286 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8287 backend public_www
8288 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8289 stats enable
8290 stats hide-version
8291 stats scope .
8292 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008293 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008294 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8295 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8296
8297 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8298 backend private_monitoring
8299 stats enable
8300 stats uri /admin?stats
8301 stats refresh 5s
8302
8303 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8304
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008305
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008306stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008307 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008309 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008310
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008311 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008312 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8313
8314 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8315 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8316
8317 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8318 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008319 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008320
8321 Example :
8322 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8323 backend private_monitoring
8324 stats enable
8325 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8326 stats uri /admin?stats
8327 stats refresh 5s
8328
8329 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8330 global section.
8331
8332
8333stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008334 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8336 yes | yes | yes | yes
8337 Arguments : none
8338
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008339 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008340 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8341 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8342 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8343 - IP (socket, server)
8344 - cookie (backend, server)
8345
8346 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8347 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008348 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008349
8350 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8351
8352
8353stats show-node [ <name> ]
8354 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008356 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008357 Arguments:
8358 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8359 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8360
8361 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8362 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008363 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008364
8365 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8366 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8367 unobvious parameters.
8368
8369 Example:
8370 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8371 backend private_monitoring
8372 stats enable
8373 stats show-node Europe-1
8374 stats uri /admin?stats
8375 stats refresh 5s
8376
8377 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8378 section.
8379
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008380
8381stats uri <prefix>
8382 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008384 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008385 Arguments :
8386 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8387 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8388 query string.
8389
8390 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8391 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8392 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8393 possible to reach it in the application.
8394
8395 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008396 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008397 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8398 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8399 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8400 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8401
8402 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8403 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8404 an address or a port to statistics only.
8405
8406 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8407 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8408 unobvious parameters.
8409
8410 Example :
8411 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8412 backend public_www
8413 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8414 stats enable
8415 stats hide-version
8416 stats scope .
8417 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008418 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008419 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8420 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8421
8422 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8423 backend private_monitoring
8424 stats enable
8425 stats uri /admin?stats
8426 stats refresh 5s
8427
8428 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8429
8430
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008431stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8432 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008434 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008435
8436 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008437 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008438 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008439 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008440 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8441
8442 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8443 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8444 the "stick-table" statement.
8445
8446 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8447 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8448 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8449 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8450 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8451
8452 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8453 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8454 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8455 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8456 transformation rules.
8457
8458 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8459 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8460 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8461 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8462 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8463 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8464 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8465
8466 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8467 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8468 ACL based conditions.
8469
8470 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8471 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8472 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8473 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8474
8475 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8476 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8477 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8478 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8479
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008480 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8481 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008482 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008483
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008484 Example :
8485 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8486 # last 30 minutes
8487 backend pop
8488 mode tcp
8489 balance roundrobin
8490 stick store-request src
8491 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8492 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8493 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8494
8495 backend smtp
8496 mode tcp
8497 balance roundrobin
8498 stick match src table pop
8499 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8500 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8501
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008502 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008503 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008504
8505
8506stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8507 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8509 no | no | yes | yes
8510
8511 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8512 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8513 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8514 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8515
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008516 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8517 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008518 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008519
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008520 Examples :
8521 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008522 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008523
8524 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8525 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8526 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8527
8528
8529 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8530 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8531 backend http
8532 mode http
8533 balance roundrobin
8534 stick on src table https
8535 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8536 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8537 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8538
8539 backend https
8540 mode tcp
8541 balance roundrobin
8542 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8543 stick on src
8544 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8545 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8546
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008547 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008548
8549
8550stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8551 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8553 no | no | yes | yes
8554
8555 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008556 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008557 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008558 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008559 server is selected.
8560
8561 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8562 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8563 the "stick-table" statement.
8564
8565 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8566 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8567 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8568 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8569 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8570 address.
8571
8572 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8573 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8574 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8575 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8576 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8577 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8578 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8579 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8580 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8581 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8582
8583 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8584 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8585 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8586 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8587 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8588 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8589 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8590
8591 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8592 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8593 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8594 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8595
8596 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8597 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8598 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8599 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8600 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8601 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008602 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8603 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8604 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8605 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8606 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8607 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008608
8609 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8610 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8611 the request.
8612
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008613 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8614 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008615 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008616
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008617 Example :
8618 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8619 # last 30 minutes
8620 backend pop
8621 mode tcp
8622 balance roundrobin
8623 stick store-request src
8624 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8625 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8626 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8627
8628 backend smtp
8629 mode tcp
8630 balance roundrobin
8631 stick match src table pop
8632 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8633 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8634
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008635 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008636 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008637
8638
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008639stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008640 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8641 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008642 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008644 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008645
8646 Arguments :
8647 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8648 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8649 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8650 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8651
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008652 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8653 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8654 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8655 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8656
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008657 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8658 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8659 instance.
8660
8661 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8662 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8663 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8664 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8665 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8666 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008667 to 32 characters.
8668
8669 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8670 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8671 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008672 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008673 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8674 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008675
8676 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008677 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8678 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008679 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8680 increase.
8681
8682 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008683 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8684 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8685 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008686
8687 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8688 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8689 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8690 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008691 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008692 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8693 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8694 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8695 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8696 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8697 parameter (see below).
8698
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008699 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8700 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8701 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8702 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8703 soft restart.
8704
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008705 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8706 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008707
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008708 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8709 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8710 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8711 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008712 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008713 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008714 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8715 if not expiration delay is specified.
8716
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008717 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8718 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8719 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8720 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008721 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8722 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8723 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8724 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8725 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8726 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8727 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8728 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8729 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8730 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8731 types and their arguments.
8732
8733 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8734 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8735 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8736 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8737
8738 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8739 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8740 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008741 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008742
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008743 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8744 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8745 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008746 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008747 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008748 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008749
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008750 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8751 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8752 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8753 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
8754
8755 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
8756 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8757 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8758 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8759 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8760 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
8761
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008762 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8763 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8764 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8765 they were received.
8766
8767 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8768 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8769 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8770 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8771 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8772
8773 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8774 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8775 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8776 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8777 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8778
8779 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8780 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8781 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8782
8783 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8784 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8785 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8786 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8787 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8788
8789 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8790 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8791 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8792 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8793 the client side.
8794
8795 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8796 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8797 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8798 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8799 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8800 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8801 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8802
8803 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8804 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8805 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8806 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8807 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8808 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008809 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008810
8811 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8812 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8813 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8814 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8815 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8816 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8817
8818 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008819 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008820 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8821 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8822
8823 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8824 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8825 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8826 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8827 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8828 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8829 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8830 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8831 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8832 recommended for better fairness.
8833
8834 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008835 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008836 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8837 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8838
8839 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8840 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8841 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8842 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8843 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8844 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8845 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8846 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8847 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8848 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008849
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008850 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8851 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008852 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8853 reference it.
8854
8855 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8856 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008857 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8858 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8859 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008860
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008861 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8862 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8863 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8864 something that can be ignored.
8865
8866 Example:
8867 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8868 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8869 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8870 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8871
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008872 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008873 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008874
8875
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008876stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008877 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8879 no | no | yes | yes
8880
8881 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008882 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008883 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008884 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008885 server is selected.
8886
8887 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8888 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8889 the "stick-table" statement.
8890
8891 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8892 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8893 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8894 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8895
8896 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8897 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8898 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8899 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8900 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8901 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008902 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008903 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8904 rules.
8905
8906 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8907 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8908 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8909 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8910 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8911 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8912 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8913
8914 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8915 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8916 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8917 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8918
8919 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8920 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8921 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8922 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8923 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8924 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008925 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8926 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8927 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8928 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8929 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8930 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8931 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8932 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8933 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008934
8935 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8936
8937 Example :
8938 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8939 backend https
8940 mode tcp
8941 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008942 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008943 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008944
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008945 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8946 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8947
8948 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8949 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8950 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8951
8952 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8953 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008954
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008955 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8956 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8957 # at offset 44.
8958
8959 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8960 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8961
8962 # Learn on response if server hello.
8963 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008964
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008965 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8966 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8967
8968 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8969 extraction.
8970
8971
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008972tcp-check connect [params*]
8973 Opens a new connection
8974 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8975 no | no | yes | yes
8976
8977 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8978 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8979 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8980
8981 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8982 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8983 of the sequence.
8984
8985 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8986 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8987 do.
8988
8989 Parameters :
8990 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8991 use the TCP connection.
8992
8993 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8994 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8995 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8996
8997 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8998
8999 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9000
9001 Examples:
9002 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9003 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9004 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9005 option tcp-check
9006 tcp-check connect
9007 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9008 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9009 tcp-check send \r\n
9010 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9011 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9012 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9013 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9014 tcp-check send \r\n
9015 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9016 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9017
9018 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9019 option tcp-check
9020 tcp-check connect port 110
9021 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9022 tcp-check connect port 143
9023 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9024 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9025
9026 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9027
9028
9029tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009030 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009031 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9032 no | no | yes | yes
9033
9034 Arguments :
9035 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9036 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9037 binary.
9038 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9039 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9040 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9041
9042 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9043 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9044 with the usual backslash ('\').
9045 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009046 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009047 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9048 used upper or lower case.
9049
9050
9051 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9052
9053 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9054 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9055 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9056 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9057 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9058 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9059 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9060 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9061
9062 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9063 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9064 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9065 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9066 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9067 expression.
9068
9069 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9070 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9071 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9072 this exact hexadecimal string.
9073 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9074
9075 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9076 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9077 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9078 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9079 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9080 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9081 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9082 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9083 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9084 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9085 the null character.
9086
9087 Examples :
9088 # perform a POP check
9089 option tcp-check
9090 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9091
9092 # perform an IMAP check
9093 option tcp-check
9094 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9095
9096 # look for the redis master server
9097 option tcp-check
9098 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009099 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009100 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9101 tcp-check expect string role:master
9102 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9103 tcp-check expect string +OK
9104
9105
9106 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9107 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9108
9109
9110tcp-check send <data>
9111 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9112 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9113 no | no | yes | yes
9114
9115 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9116 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9117
9118 Examples :
9119 # look for the redis master server
9120 option tcp-check
9121 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9122 tcp-check expect string role:master
9123
9124 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9125 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9126
9127
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009128tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9129 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009130 tcp health check
9131 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9132 no | no | yes | yes
9133
9134 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9135 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009136 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009137 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9138 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9139 hexadecimal string.
9140 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9141
9142 Examples :
9143 # redis check in binary
9144 option tcp-check
9145 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9146 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9147
9148
9149 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9150 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9151
9152
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009153tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9154 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9156 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009157 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009158 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9159 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009160
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009161 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009162
9163 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9164 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009165 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9166 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9167 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9168 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9169 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9170 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009171
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009172 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9173 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9174 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9175 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009176
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009177 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009178 - accept :
9179 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9180 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9181 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009182
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009183 - reject :
9184 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9185 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9186 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9187 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9188 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9189 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9190 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9191 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9192 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9193 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9194 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009195 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009196
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009197 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9198 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9199 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9200 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9201 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9202 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9203 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9204 hosts.
9205
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009206 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9207 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9208 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9209 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9210 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9211 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9212 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9213 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9214
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009215 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9216 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9217 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9218 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9219 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9220 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9221 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9222 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9223 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009224 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9225 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009226
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009227 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009228 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02009229 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009230 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009231 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9232 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009233 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009234 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
9235 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
9236 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
9237 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
9238 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009239
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009240 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009241 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009242 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009243 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009244 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9245 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9246 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009247
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009248 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9249 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9250 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9251 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009252
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009253 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9254 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9255 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9256 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9257 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009258 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9259 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9260 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9261 layer7 information is extracted.
9262
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009263 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9264 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9265 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9266 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9267 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009268
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009269 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9270 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9271 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9272 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9273
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009274 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9275 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9276 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9277 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9278
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009279 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9280 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9281 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9282 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9283 continues.
9284
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009285 - set-src <expr> :
9286 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9287 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9288 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9289 set-src"
9290
9291 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9292 followed by some converters.
9293
9294 Example:
9295
9296 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9297
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009298 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9299 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009300
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009301 - set-src-port <expr> :
9302 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9303 expression.
9304
9305 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9306 followed by some converters.
9307
9308 Example:
9309
9310 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9311
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009312 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9313 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9314 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009315
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009316 - set-dst <expr> :
9317 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9318 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9319 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9320 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9321 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9322
9323 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9324 followed by some converters.
9325
9326 Example:
9327
9328 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9329 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9330
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009331 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9332 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9333
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009334 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9335 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9336 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9337 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9338
9339
9340 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9341 followed by some converters.
9342
9343 Example:
9344
9345 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9346
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009347 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9348 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9349 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9350
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009351 - "silent-drop" :
9352 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009353 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009354 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9355 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9356 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9357 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9358 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009359 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9360 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009361 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9362 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009363 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009364 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9365 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9366 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9367 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9368
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009369 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9370 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9371 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009372
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009373 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9374 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9375 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009376
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009377 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009378 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009379 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009380
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009381 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9382 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9383 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009384
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009385 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009386 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9387 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009388
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009389 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9390
9391 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9392
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009393 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9394
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009395 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009396
9397
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009398tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9399 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009401 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009402 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009403 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9404 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009405
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009406 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009407
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009408 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009409 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9410 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9411 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9412 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009413
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009414 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9415 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9416 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9417 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009418 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9419 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9420 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9421 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9422 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9423 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009424 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009425 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009426
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009427 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9428 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9429 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9430 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009431
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009432 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009433 - accept : the request is accepted
9434 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9435 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009436 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009437 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009438 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009439 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009440 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009441 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009442 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009443 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009444
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009445 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9446 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009447
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009448 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9449 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9450 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9451 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9452 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9453 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009455 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009456 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9457 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009458
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009459 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009460 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9461 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9462 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9463 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009464 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9465 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9466 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009467
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009468 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009469 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9470 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9471 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009472
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009473 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009474 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9475 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009476
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009477 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9478 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009479 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009480 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9481 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009482 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009483 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009484 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009485 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9486 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009487 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009488 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9489 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009490
9491 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9492 followed by some converters.
9493
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009494 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9495 <var-name>.
9496
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009497 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9498 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9499 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9500 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9501 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9502
9503 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9504
9505 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9506
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009507 Example:
9508
9509 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009510 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009511
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009512 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009513 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9514 # and reject everything else.
9515 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9516 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009517 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009518 tcp-request content reject
9519
9520 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009521 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9522 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9523 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009524 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009525
9526 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9527 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9528 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009529 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009530 tcp-request content reject
9531
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009532 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009533 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009534 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009535 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009536 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9537 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009538
9539 Example:
9540 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9541 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009542 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009543
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009544 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009545 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009546
9547 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009548 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009549 # protecting all our sites
9550 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009551 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9552 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009553 ...
9554 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9555
9556 backend http_dynamic
9557 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009558 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009559 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009560 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009561 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009562 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009563 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009564
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009565 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009566
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009567 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9568 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009569
9570
9571tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9572 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009574 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009575 Arguments :
9576 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9577 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9578 as explained at the top of this document.
9579
9580 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9581 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9582 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9583 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9584 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9585
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009586 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9587 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9588 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9589 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9590
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009591 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9592 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009593 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009594 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009595 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9596 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9597 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9598 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009599
9600 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9601 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9602 it pass through unaffected.
9603
9604 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9605 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9606 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009607 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009608 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9609 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009610 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9611 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9612 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009613
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009614 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009615 "timeout client".
9616
9617
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009618tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9619 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9621 no | no | yes | yes
9622 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009623 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9624 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009625
9626 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9627
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009628 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009629 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9630 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009631 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9632 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009633
9634 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9635
9636 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9637 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9638 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9639 inserted.
9640
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009641 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009642 - accept :
9643 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9644 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9645 the rules evaluation.
9646
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009647 - close :
9648 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9649 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9650 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9651 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9652 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9653 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009654 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009655 protocols.
9656
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009657 - reject :
9658 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9659 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009660 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009661
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009662 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9663 Sets a variable.
9664
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009665 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9666 Unsets a variable.
9667
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009668 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9669 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9670 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9671 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9672
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009673 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9674 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9675 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9676 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9677
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009678 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9679 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9680 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9681 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9682 continues.
9683
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009684 - "silent-drop" :
9685 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009686 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009687 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9688 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9689 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9690 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9691 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009692 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9693 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009694 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9695 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009696 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009697 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9698 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9699 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9700 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9701
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009702 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9703 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9704
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009705 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9706 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9707 for changing the default action to a reject.
9708
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009709 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9710 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9711 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9712 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009713 period.
9714
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009715 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9716 declared inline.
9717
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009718 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9719 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009720 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009721 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9722 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009723 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009724 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009725 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009726 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9727 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009728 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009729 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9730 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009731
9732 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9733 followed by some converters.
9734
9735 Example:
9736
9737 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9738
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009739 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9740 <var-name>.
9741
9742 Example:
9743
9744 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9745
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009746 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9747 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9748 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9749 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9750 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9751
9752 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9753
9754 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9755
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009756 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9757
9758 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9759
9760
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009761tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9762 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9764 no | yes | yes | no
9765 Arguments :
9766 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9767 below.
9768
9769 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9770
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009771 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009772 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9773 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9774 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9775 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9776 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9777 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9778 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009779 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009780 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9781 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9782 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9783 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9784 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9785 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9786 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9787 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9788 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9789 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9790 instead.
9791
9792 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9793 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9794 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9795 rules which may be inserted.
9796
9797 Several types of actions are supported :
9798 - accept : the request is accepted
9799 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9800 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9801 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009802 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009803 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9804 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009805 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009806 - silent-drop
9807
9808 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9809 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9810 sections for a complete description.
9811
9812 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9813 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9814 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9815
9816 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9817 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9818 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9819 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9820 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9821
9822 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9823 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9824
9825 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9826 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9827 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9828
9829 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9830 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9831 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9832
9833 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9834 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9835 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9836
9837 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9838 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9839 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9840
9841 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9842
9843 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9844
9845
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009846tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9847 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9849 no | no | yes | yes
9850 Arguments :
9851 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9852 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9853 as explained at the top of this document.
9854
9855 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9856
9857
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009858timeout check <timeout>
9859 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9860 established.
9861
9862 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9863 yes | no | yes | yes
9864 Arguments:
9865 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9866 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9867 as explained at the top of this document.
9868
9869 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9870 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009871 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009872 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009873 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9874 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9875 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009876
9877 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9878 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9879
9880 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9881 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009882 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009883
9884 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9885 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9886 forget about it.
9887
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009888 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9889 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009890
9891
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009892timeout client <timeout>
9893timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9894 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9896 yes | yes | yes | no
9897 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009898 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009899 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9900 as explained at the top of this document.
9901
9902 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9903 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9904 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009905 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9906 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9907 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9908 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009909 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9910 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9911 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009912 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009913 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009914 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9915 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009916 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9917 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009918
9919 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9920 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9921 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9922 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9923 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9924 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9925
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +01009926 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +01009927
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009928 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9929 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9930 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9931
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009932 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9933 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009934
9935
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009936timeout client-fin <timeout>
9937 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9939 yes | yes | yes | no
9940 Arguments :
9941 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9942 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9943 as explained at the top of this document.
9944
9945 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9946 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9947 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9948 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9949 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9950 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9951 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +01009952 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
9953 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
9954 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009955
9956 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9957 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9958 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9959
9960 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9961
9962
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009963timeout connect <timeout>
9964timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9965 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9967 yes | no | yes | yes
9968 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009969 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009970 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9971 as explained at the top of this document.
9972
9973 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009974 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009975 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009976 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009977 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9978 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009979
9980 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9981 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9982 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9983 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9984 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9985 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9986
9987 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9988 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9989 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9990
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009991 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9992 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009993
9994
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009995timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9996 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9998 yes | yes | yes | yes
9999 Arguments :
10000 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10001 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10002 as explained at the top of this document.
10003
10004 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10005 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10006 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10007 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10008 once the request has started to present itself.
10009
10010 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10011 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10012 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10013 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10014 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10015
10016 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10017 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10018 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10019 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10020
10021 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10022 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010023 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010024 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10025 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010026 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010027
10028 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10029 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10030 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10031 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10032
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010033 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10034 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010035 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10036
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010037 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10038
10039
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010040timeout http-request <timeout>
10041 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010043 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010044 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010045 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010046 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10047 as explained at the top of this document.
10048
10049 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10050 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10051 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10052 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10053 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10054 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10055 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010056 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10057 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10058 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10059 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010060 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010061 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10062 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010063
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010064 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10065 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10066 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10067 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10068 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010069 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010070
10071 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10072 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010073 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010074 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10075 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10076
10077 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010078 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10079 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10080 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010081
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010082 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010083 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010084
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010085
10086timeout queue <timeout>
10087 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10089 yes | no | yes | yes
10090 Arguments :
10091 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10092 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10093 as explained at the top of this document.
10094
10095 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10096 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10097 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10098 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10099 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10100
10101 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10102 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10103 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10104 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10105
10106 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10107
10108
10109timeout server <timeout>
10110timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10111 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10113 yes | no | yes | yes
10114 Arguments :
10115 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10116 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10117 as explained at the top of this document.
10118
10119 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10120 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10121 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10122 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10123 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10124 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10125 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10126
10127 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10128 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10129 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10130 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10131 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010132 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010133 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010134 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10135 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010136 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10137 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010138
10139 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10140 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10141 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10142 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10143 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10144 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10145
10146 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10147 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10148 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10149
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010150 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010151
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010152
10153timeout server-fin <timeout>
10154 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10156 yes | no | yes | yes
10157 Arguments :
10158 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10159 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10160 as explained at the top of this document.
10161
10162 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10163 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10164 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10165 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10166 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10167 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10168 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10169 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10170 situations, it should not be needed.
10171
10172 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10173 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10174 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10175
10176 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10177
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010178
10179timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010180 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10182 yes | yes | yes | yes
10183 Arguments :
10184 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10185 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10186 as explained at the top of this document.
10187
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010188 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10189 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10190 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10191 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010192
10193 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10194 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10195 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10196 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010197 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010198
10199 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10200
10201
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010202timeout tunnel <timeout>
10203 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10205 yes | no | yes | yes
10206 Arguments :
10207 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10208 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10209 as explained at the top of this document.
10210
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010211 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010212 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10213 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10214 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010215 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10216 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010217 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10218 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10219 specified.
10220
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010221 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10222 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10223 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10224 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10225 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10226 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10227 state.
10228
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010229 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10230 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10231 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10232 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010233 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010234
10235 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10236 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10237 forget about it.
10238
10239 Example :
10240 defaults http
10241 option http-server-close
10242 timeout connect 5s
10243 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010244 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010245 timeout server 30s
10246 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10247
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010248 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010249
10250
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010251transparent (deprecated)
10252 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010254 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010255 Arguments : none
10256
10257 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10258 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10259 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10260 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10261 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10262 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10263 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10264 appropriate server.
10265
10266 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10267
10268 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10269 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10270
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010271 See also: "option transparent"
10272
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010273unique-id-format <string>
10274 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10276 yes | yes | yes | no
10277 Arguments :
10278 <string> is a log-format string.
10279
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010280 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10281 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10282 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10283 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010284
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010285 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10286 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10287 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10288 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10289 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10290 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10291 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10292 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010293
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010294 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10295 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010296
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010297 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010298
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010299 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010300
10301 will generate:
10302
10303 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10304
10305 See also: "unique-id-header"
10306
10307unique-id-header <name>
10308 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10310 yes | yes | yes | no
10311 Arguments :
10312 <name> is the name of the header.
10313
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010314 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10315 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010316
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010317 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010318
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010319 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010320 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10321
10322 will generate:
10323
10324 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10325
10326 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010327
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010328use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010329 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10331 no | yes | yes | no
10332 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010333 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10334 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010335
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010336 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10337 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010338
10339 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10340 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10341 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010342 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010343 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010344 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10345 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010346
10347 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10348 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10349 assign the backend.
10350
10351 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10352 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10353 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10354 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10355 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10356 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10357
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010358 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010359 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010360 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10361 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10362 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10363
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010364 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10365 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10366 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10367 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10368 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10369 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10370 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10371 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10372 cannot be forced from the request.
10373
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010374 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010375 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10376 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10377
10378 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10379 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010380
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010381
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010382use-server <server> if <condition>
10383use-server <server> unless <condition>
10384 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10386 no | no | yes | yes
10387 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010388 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010389
10390 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10391
10392 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10393 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10394 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10395
10396 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10397 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10398 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10399 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10400 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10401 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10402 matches will assign the server.
10403
10404 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10405 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10406 with the next rules until one matches.
10407
10408 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10409 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10410 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10411 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10412
10413 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10414 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10415 stripped.
10416
10417 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10418 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10419 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10420 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10421
10422 Example :
10423 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10424 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10425 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10426 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10427 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10428 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010429 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010430 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10431 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10432
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010433 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010434
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010435
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100104365. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010437--------------------------
10438
10439The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10440depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10441settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10442written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10443described in this section.
10444
10445
104465.1. Bind options
10447-----------------
10448
10449The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10450as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10451no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10452parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10453while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10454provided immediately after the setting name.
10455
10456The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10457
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010458accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10459 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10460 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10461 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10462 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10463 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10464 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10465 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10466 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10467 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010468 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10469 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10470 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010471
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010472accept-proxy
10473 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010474 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10475 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010476 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10477 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10478 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10479 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010480 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010481 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10482 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010483 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10484 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010485
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010486allow-0rtt
10487 Allow receiving early data when using TLS 1.3. This is disabled by default,
10488 due to security considerations.
10489
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010490alpn <protocols>
10491 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10492 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10493 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10494 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10495 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010496 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10497 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10498 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10499 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10500 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10501 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10502 preference, like below :
10503
10504 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010505
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010506backlog <backlog>
10507 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10508 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10509
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010510curves <curves>
10511 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10512 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10513 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10514 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10515 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10516 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10517
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010518ecdhe <named curve>
10519 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010520 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10521 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010522
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010523ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010524 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10525 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10526 client's certificate.
10527
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010528ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10529 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10530 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10531 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10532 error is ignored.
10533
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010534ca-sign-file <cafile>
10535 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10536 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10537 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10538 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10539 'generate-certificates' for details.
10540
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010541ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010542 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10543 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10544 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10545 'generate-certificates' for details.
10546
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010547ciphers <ciphers>
10548 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10549 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010550 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010551 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10552 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010553 Depending on the compatibility and security requirements, the list of suitable
Daniel Schneller87e43022017-09-01 19:29:57 +020010554 ciphers depends on a variety of variables. For background information and
10555 recommendations see e. g. (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS)
10556 and (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010557
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010558crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010559 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10560 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10561 to verify client's certificate.
10562
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010563crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010564 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10565 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10566 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10567 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10568 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10569 file.
10570
10571 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10572 are loaded.
10573
10574 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010575 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010576 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10577 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10578 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10579 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010580 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10581 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010582 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010583
10584 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10585 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10586 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10587 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010588 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10589 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010590
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010591 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010592
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010593 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010594 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010595 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10596 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010597 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10598 clients).
10599
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010600 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10601 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10602 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10603 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10604 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10605 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10606 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10607 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10608 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10609 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10610 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10611 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10612 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10613
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010614 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10615 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10616 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10617 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10618 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10619
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010620 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10621 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10622 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10623 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010624
10625 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10626 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10627 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10628 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10629 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10630 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10631 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10632 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10633 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10634
10635 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10636
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010637 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010638 a cert bundle.
10639
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010640 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010641 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10642 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10643 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10644 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10645 provide multi-cert support.
10646
10647 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10648
10649 Filename | CN | SAN
10650 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10651 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010652 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010653 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10654 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10655
10656 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10657 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10658 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10659 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010660 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10661 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10662 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010663
10664 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10665 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10666
10667 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10668 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10669 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10670
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010671crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010672 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010673 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010674 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010675 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010676
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010677crt-list <file>
10678 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010679 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10680 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010681
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010682 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10683
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010684 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10685 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010686 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010687 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010688
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010689 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10690 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10691 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10692 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10693 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10694 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10695 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10696 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010697
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010698 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010699 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010700 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10701 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10702 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010703
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010704 crt-list file example:
10705 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010706 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010707 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010708 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010709
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010710defer-accept
10711 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10712 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10713 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010714 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010715 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10716 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10717 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10718 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10719 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10720 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10721 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10722
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010723expose-fd listeners
10724 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10725 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010726 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10727 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010728 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010729
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010730force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010731 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010732 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010733 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010734 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010735
10736force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010737 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010738 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010739 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010740
10741force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010742 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010743 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010744 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010745
10746force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010747 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010748 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010749 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010750
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010751force-tlsv13
10752 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10753 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010754 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010755
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010756generate-certificates
10757 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10758 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10759 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10760 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10761 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10762 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10763 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10764 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10765 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10766 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10767 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10768
10769 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10770 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010771 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010772 certificate is used many times.
10773
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010774gid <gid>
10775 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10776 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10777 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10778 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10779 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10780
10781group <group>
10782 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10783 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10784 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10785 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10786 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10787
10788id <id>
10789 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10790 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10791 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10792 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10793
10794interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010795 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10796 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10797 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10798 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10799 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10800 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010010801 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
10802 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
10803 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
10804 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
10805 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
10806 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010807
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010808level <level>
10809 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10810 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10811 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010812 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010813 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10814 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10815 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010816 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010817 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010818 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010819 all counters).
10820
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020010821severity-output <format>
10822 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
10823 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
10824 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
10825 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
10826 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
10827 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
10828 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
10829 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
10830 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
10831 rfc5424 convention.
10832
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010833maxconn <maxconn>
10834 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10835 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10836 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10837 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10838 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10839 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10840 eat all memory.
10841
10842mode <mode>
10843 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10844 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10845 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10846 UNIX sockets.
10847
10848mss <maxseg>
10849 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10850 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10851 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10852 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10853 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10854 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10855 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10856 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10857 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10858 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10859 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10860
10861name <name>
10862 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10863 page.
10864
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010865namespace <name>
10866 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10867 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10868 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10869 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10870
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010871nice <nice>
10872 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10873 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10874 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10875 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10876 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10877 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10878 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10879 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10880 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10881 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10882 one for an RDP socket.
10883
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010884no-ca-names
10885 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10886 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
10887
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010888no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010889 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010890 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010891 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010892 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010893 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
10894 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010895
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010896no-tls-tickets
10897 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10898 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10899 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010900 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10901 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010902
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010903no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010904 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010905 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010906 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010907 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010908 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10909 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010910
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010911no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010912 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010913 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010914 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010915 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010916 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10917 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010918
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010919no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010920 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010921 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010922 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010923 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010924 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10925 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010926
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010927no-tlsv13
10928 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10929 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
10930 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
10931 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010932 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10933 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010934
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010935npn <protocols>
10936 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10937 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10938 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10939 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010940 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010941 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
10942 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
10943 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
10944 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
10945 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010946
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000010947prefer-client-ciphers
10948 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
10949 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
10950 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
10951
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010010952process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
10953 This restricts the list of processes and/or threads on which this listener is
10954 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010955 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010010956 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
10957 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
10958 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
10959 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010960 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010010961 connections for this listener, for the corresponding process set. For the
10962 unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
10963 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
10964
10965 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
10966
10967 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
10968 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
10969 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
10970 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
10971 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
10972 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
10973 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
10974 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010975
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010976ssl
10977 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010978 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010979 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10980 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020010981 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
10982 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010983
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010984ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10985 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
10986 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10987 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
10988
10989ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10990 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
10991 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10992 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
10993
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010994strict-sni
10995 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10996 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10997 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10998 See the "crt" option for more information.
10999
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011000tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011001 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011002 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11003 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011004 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011005 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11006 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11007 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11008 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11009 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11010 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11011 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11012
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011013tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011014 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011015 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11016 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11017 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11018 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11019 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11020 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11021 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011022 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11023 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11024 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011025
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011026tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11027 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
11028 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
11029 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
11030 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
11031 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
11032 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
11033 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
11034 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
11035 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11036 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11037
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011038transparent
11039 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11040 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11041 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11042 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11043 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11044 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11045 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11046 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11047 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11048 so check for support with your vendor.
11049
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011050v4v6
11051 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11052 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11053 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11054 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011055 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011056
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011057v6only
11058 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11059 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11060 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011061 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11062 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011063
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011064uid <uid>
11065 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11066 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11067 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11068 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11069 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11070
11071user <user>
11072 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11073 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11074 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11075 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11076 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11077
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011078verify [none|optional|required]
11079 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11080 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11081 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11082 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11083 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011084 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11085 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11086 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11087 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011088
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200110895.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011090------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011091
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011092The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11093which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11094arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11095settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11096after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11097Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11098address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011100 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011101 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011102
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011103Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11104keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11105
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011106The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011107
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011108addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011109 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011110 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11111 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11112 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11113 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11114 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011115
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011116agent-check
11117 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011118 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
11119 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
11120 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
11121 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011122
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011123 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011124 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011125 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11126 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11127 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011128
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011129 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11130 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11131 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11132 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11133 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011134
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011135 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011136 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011137
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011138 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11139 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11140 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011141
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011142 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11143 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11144 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011145
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011146 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11147 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11148 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11149 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11150 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011151 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011152 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011153
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011154 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11155 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011156
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011157 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11158 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11159 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11160 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11161 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11162 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11163 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11164 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11165 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011166
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011167 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11168 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011169 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11170 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11171 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011172 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011173
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011174 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011175 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011176
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011177agent-send <string>
11178 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11179 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11180 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11181 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11182 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11183
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011184agent-inter <delay>
11185 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11186 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11187
11188 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11189 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11190 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11191 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11192 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11193 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11194 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11195 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11196 of backends use the same servers.
11197
11198 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11199
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011200agent-addr <addr>
11201 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11202
11203 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11204 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11205 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11206 hostname, it will be resolved.
11207
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011208agent-port <port>
11209 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11210
11211 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011213backup
11214 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11215 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11216 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11217 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011218 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11219 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011220
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011221ca-file <cafile>
11222 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11223 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11224 server's certificate.
11225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011226check
11227 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011228 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11229 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11230 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11231 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11232 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11233 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11234 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011235 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11236 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011237 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11238 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011239
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011240check-send-proxy
11241 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11242 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11243 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11244 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11245 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11246 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11247 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11248
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011249check-sni
11250 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
11251 over SSL.
11252
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011253check-ssl
11254 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11255 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11256 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11257 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011258 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011259 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11260 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011261 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011262 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11263 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011264
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011265ciphers <ciphers>
11266 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011267 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011268 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
11269 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
11270 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
11271 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
11272 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
11273 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
11274
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011275cookie <value>
11276 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11277 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11278 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11279 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11280 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11281 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11282 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11283
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011284crl-file <crlfile>
11285 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11286 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11287 to verify server's certificate.
11288
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011289crt <cert>
11290 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11291 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11292 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11293 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11294 certificate request.
11295
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011296disabled
11297 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11298 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11299 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11300 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11301 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011302 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011303
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011304enabled
11305 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11306 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11307 default value.
11308 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11309 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011310
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011311error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011312 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11313 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11314 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011315
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011316 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011317
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011318fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011319 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11320 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11321 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11322
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011323force-sslv3
11324 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11325 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011326 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011327 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011328
11329force-tlsv10
11330 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011331 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011332 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011333
11334force-tlsv11
11335 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011336 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011337 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011338
11339force-tlsv12
11340 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011341 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011342 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011343
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011344force-tlsv13
11345 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11346 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011347 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011348
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011349id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011350 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11351 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11352 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011353
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011354init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11355 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11356 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011357 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011358 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11359 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11360 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11361 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11362 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11363 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11364 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11365 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11366 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011367 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011368 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11369 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11370 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11371 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11372 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11373 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011374 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011375
11376 Example:
11377 defaults
11378 # never fail on address resolution
11379 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11380
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011381inter <delay>
11382fastinter <delay>
11383downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011384 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11385 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11386 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11387 between checks depending on the server state :
11388
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011389 Server state | Interval used
11390 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11391 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11392 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11393 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11394 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11395 or yet unchecked. |
11396 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11397 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11398 | "inter" otherwise.
11399 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011400
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011401 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11402 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11403 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11404 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011405 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11406 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11407 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11408 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11409 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011410
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011411maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011412 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11413 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11414 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11415 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11416 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11417 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11418 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11419 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11420
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011421maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011422 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11423 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11424 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11425 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11426 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11427 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11428 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11429
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011430minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011431 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11432 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11433 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11434 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11435 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11436 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011437 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011438 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011439
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011440namespace <name>
11441 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11442 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11443 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11444 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11445
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011446no-agent-check
11447 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11448 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11449 default value.
11450 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11451 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11452
11453no-backup
11454 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11455 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11456 default value.
11457 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11458 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11459
11460no-check
11461 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11462 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11463 default value.
11464 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11465 "default-server" "check" setting.
11466
11467no-check-ssl
11468 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11469 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11470 default value.
11471 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11472 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11473
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011474no-send-proxy
11475 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11476 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11477 default value.
11478 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11479 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11480
11481no-send-proxy-v2
11482 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11483 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11484 default value.
11485 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11486 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11487
11488no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11489 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11490 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11491 default value.
11492 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11493 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11494
11495no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11496 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11497 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11498 default value.
11499 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11500 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11501
11502no-ssl
11503 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11504 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11505 default value.
11506 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11507 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11508
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011509no-ssl-reuse
11510 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11511 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11512 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11513 and for paranoid users.
11514
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011515no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011516 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11517 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011518 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011519
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011520 Supported in default-server: No
11521
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011522no-tls-tickets
11523 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11524 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11525 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011526 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11527 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011528 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011529
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011530no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011531 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011532 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11533 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011534 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11535 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011536 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011537
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011538 Supported in default-server: No
11539
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011540no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011541 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011542 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11543 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011544 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11545 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011546 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011547
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011548 Supported in default-server: No
11549
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011550no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011551 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011552 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11553 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011554 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11555 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011556 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011557
11558 Supported in default-server: No
11559
11560no-tlsv13
11561 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11562 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11563 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11564 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11565 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011566 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011567
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011568 Supported in default-server: No
11569
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011570no-verifyhost
11571 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11572 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11573 default value.
11574 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11575 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011576
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011577non-stick
11578 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11579 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11580 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11581
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011582observe <mode>
11583 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11584 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11585 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11586 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11587 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11588 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011589 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011590
11591 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11592
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011593on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011594 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11595 Currently, four modes are available:
11596 - fastinter: force fastinter
11597 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11598 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11599 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11600 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11601
11602 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11603
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011604on-marked-down <action>
11605 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11606 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011607 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11608 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11609 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11610 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11611 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11612 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11613 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11614 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011615
11616 Actions are disabled by default
11617
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011618on-marked-up <action>
11619 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11620 Currently one action is available:
11621 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11622 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11623 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11624 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011625 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11626 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011627 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11628 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11629
11630 Actions are disabled by default
11631
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011632port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011633 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11634 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11635 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11636 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11637 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11638 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11639
11640redir <prefix>
11641 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11642 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11643 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11644 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11645 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11646 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11647 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11648 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011649 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011650 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011651 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11652 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11653 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11654 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11655
11656 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11657
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011658rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011659 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11660 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11661 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11662
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011663resolve-prefer <family>
11664 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11665 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11666 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11667 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11668
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011669 Default value: ipv6
11670
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011671 Example:
11672
11673 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011674
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011675resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11676 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11677 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011678 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011679 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11680 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011681 configured network, another address is selected.
11682
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011683 Example:
11684
11685 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011686
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011687resolvers <id>
11688 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11689 hostname.
11690
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011691 Example:
11692
11693 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011694
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011695 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011696
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011697send-proxy
11698 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11699 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11700 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11701 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011702 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11703 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11704 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11705 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11706 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11707 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11708 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11709 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11710 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11711 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011712 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11713 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011714
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011715send-proxy-v2
11716 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11717 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11718 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11719 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020011720 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
11721 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
11722 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
11723 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011724
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010011725proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
11726 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
11727 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010011728 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
11729 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010011730 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
11731 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010011732 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010011733
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011734send-proxy-v2-ssl
11735 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11736 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11737 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11738 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11739 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11740 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11741 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011742 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11743 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011744
11745send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11746 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11747 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11748 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11749 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11750 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11751 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11752 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11753 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011754 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
11755 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011756
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011757slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011758 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11759 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11760 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11761 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11762 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11763 parameters :
11764
11765 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11766 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11767
11768 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11769 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11770 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11771 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11772
11773 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11774 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11775 seen as failed.
11776
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011777sni <expression>
11778 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11779 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11780 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11781 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020011782 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
11783 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011784 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
11785 "verify" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011786
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011787source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011788source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011789source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011790 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11791 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11792 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11793 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11794
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011795 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11796 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11797 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11798 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11799 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11800 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11801 server.
11802
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011803 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11804 specifying the source address without port(s).
11805
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011806ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011807 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11808 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11809 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11810 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11811 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11812 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011813 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
11814 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011815
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011816ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11817 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
11818 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11819 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11820
11821ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11822 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
11823 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11824 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11825
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011826ssl-reuse
11827 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
11828 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11829 default value.
11830 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11831 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
11832
11833stick
11834 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
11835 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11836 default value.
11837 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11838 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011839
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011840tcp-ut <delay>
11841 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11842 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11843 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011844 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011845 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11846 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11847 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11848 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11849 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11850 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11851 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11852 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11853 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11854
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011855track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011856 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11857 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11858 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11859 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011860 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11861
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011862tls-tickets
11863 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
11864 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11865 default value.
11866 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11867 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011868
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011869verify [none|required]
11870 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011871 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011872 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
11873 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011874 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011875 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
11876 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
11877 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
11878 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
11879 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
11880 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
11881 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
11882 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011883
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011884verifyhost <hostname>
11885 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011886 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
11887 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
11888 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
11889 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
11890 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
11891 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
11892 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
11893 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011894
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011895weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011896 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11897 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11898 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011899 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11900 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11901 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11902 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11903 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11904 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011905
11906
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200119075.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11908-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011909
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011910HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11911using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11912configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011913This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11914can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11915workload.
11916This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11917resolution at run time.
11918Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11919carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11920
11921
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200119225.3.1. Global overview
11923----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011924
11925As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11926different steps of the process life:
11927
11928 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11929 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11930 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11931
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011932 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
11933 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011934
11935A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11936 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11937 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11938 resolution to know this new IP.
11939
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011940When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011941HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011942SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
11943from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
11944will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
11945will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020011946
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011947A few things important to notice:
11948 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11949 first valid response.
11950
11951 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11952 servers return an error.
11953
11954
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200119555.3.2. The resolvers section
11956----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011957
11958This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011959HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
11960contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011961
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011962When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11963uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11964is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11965answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11966
11967When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011968used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011969
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011970 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
11971 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
11972 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011973
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011974 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
11975 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011976
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011977 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
11978 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
11979 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011980
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011981For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
11982following scenarios are possible:
11983
11984 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
11985 ignored
11986
11987 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11988 applied
11989
11990 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11991 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
11992
11993 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
11994 retries the query with a new type
11995
11996 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
11997 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011998
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011999As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12000a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012001<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012002
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012003
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012004resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012005 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012006
12007A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12008
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012009accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012010 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012011 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012012 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12013 by RFC 6891)
12014
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012015 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12016
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012017nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12018 DNS server description:
12019 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12020 <ip> : IP address of the server
12021 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12022
12023hold <status> <period>
12024 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12025 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012026 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012027 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012028 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12029 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12030 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12031
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012032 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012033
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012034resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012035 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12036 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12037 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12038
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012039resolve_retries <nb>
12040 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12041 giving up.
12042 Default value: 3
12043
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012044 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12045 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12046 type.
12047
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012048timeout <event> <time>
12049 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12050 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12051 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012052 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12053 other time applied.
12054 Default value: 1s
12055 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
12056 have been received.
12057 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012058 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12059 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12060
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012061 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012062
12063 resolvers mydns
12064 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12065 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
12066 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012067 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012068 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012069 hold other 30s
12070 hold refused 30s
12071 hold nx 30s
12072 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012073 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012074 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012075
12076
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120776. HTTP header manipulation
12078---------------------------
12079
12080In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12081response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12082request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12083which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012084against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012085
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012086If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12087to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12088but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12089HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12090stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12091because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12092a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12093still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012094
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012095This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12096in section 4.2 :
12097
12098 - reqadd <string>
12099 - reqallow <search>
12100 - reqiallow <search>
12101 - reqdel <search>
12102 - reqidel <search>
12103 - reqdeny <search>
12104 - reqideny <search>
12105 - reqpass <search>
12106 - reqipass <search>
12107 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12108 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12109 - reqtarpit <search>
12110 - reqitarpit <search>
12111 - rspadd <string>
12112 - rspdel <search>
12113 - rspidel <search>
12114 - rspdeny <search>
12115 - rspideny <search>
12116 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12117 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12118
12119With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12120is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12121parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12122prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12123Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12124
12125 \t for a tab
12126 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12127 \n for a new line (LF)
12128 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12129 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12130 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12131 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12132 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12133
12134The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12135portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12136above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12137regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
121389 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12139is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12140
12141The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12142after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12143
12144Notes related to these keywords :
12145---------------------------------
12146 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12147 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12148 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12149
12150 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12151 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12152 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12153
12154 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12155 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12156 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12157 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12158 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12159
12160 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12161 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12162 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12163 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12164 useless headers before adding new ones.
12165
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012166 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012167 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12168
12169 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12170 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12171 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12172
12173 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12174 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012175 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012176
12177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121787. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12179----------------------------------
12180
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012181HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012182client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12183The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12184these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12185but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12186data called patterns.
12187
12188
121897.1. ACL basics
12190---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012191
12192The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12193content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12194from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12195simple :
12196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012197 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012198 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012199 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12200 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012202The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12203adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012204
12205In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012207 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012208
12209This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12210Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12211and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012212an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12213conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12214as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12215are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012216
12217ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12218'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12219which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12220
12221There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12222performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012224The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12225specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12226this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012227methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12228ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012229
12230Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12231 - boolean
12232 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12233 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12234 - string
12235 - data block
12236
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012237Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12238converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12239would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12240The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12241which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12242
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012243Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12244keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12245fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12246which are summarized in the table below :
12247
12248 +---------------------+-----------------+
12249 | Sample or converter | Default |
12250 | output type | matching method |
12251 +---------------------+-----------------+
12252 | boolean | bool |
12253 +---------------------+-----------------+
12254 | integer | int |
12255 +---------------------+-----------------+
12256 | ip | ip |
12257 +---------------------+-----------------+
12258 | string | str |
12259 +---------------------+-----------------+
12260 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12261 +---------------------+-----------------+
12262
12263Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12264matching method, see below.
12265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012266The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12267 - boolean
12268 - integer or integer range
12269 - IP address / network
12270 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12271 - regular expression
12272 - hex block
12273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012274The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12275
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012276 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12277 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012278 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012279 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012280 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012281 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012282 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012284The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12285read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12286if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12287lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12288will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12289beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12290a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12291lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12292exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12293
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012294The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12295parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12296ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12297a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12298check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12299
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012300The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12301socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12302file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012304Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12305loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12306
12307 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12308
12309In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12310the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12311case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12312as well.
12313
12314The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12315sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12316do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12317methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12318is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012319obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012320followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12321default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12322that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12323string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12324
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012325The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12326By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12327string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12328resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12329server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12330waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12331flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12332function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012334There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12335sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12336be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012337
12338 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12339 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012340 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12341 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12342 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12343 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012344
12345 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12346 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012347 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012348
12349 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012350 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012351
12352 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012353 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012354
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012355 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012356 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12357
12358 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12359 binary or string samples.
12360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012361 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12362 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012364 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12365 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12366 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012368 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12369 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012371 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12372 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012374 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12375 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012377 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12378 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012379 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012381 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12382 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12383 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012384
12385For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12386request, it is possible to do :
12387
12388 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12389
12390In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12391buffer, one would use the following acl :
12392
12393 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12394
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012395On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12396possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12397
12398 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012400All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12401criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12402method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12403to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12404criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12405the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012407If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012408the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12409For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012411 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12412 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12413 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12414 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012415
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012416
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012417The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12418types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12419combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12420brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12421default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012423 +-------------------------------------------------+
12424 | Input sample type |
12425 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012426 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012427 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12428 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12429 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012430 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012431 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012432 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012433 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012434 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012435 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012436 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012437 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012438 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012439 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012440 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012441 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012442 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012443 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012444 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012445 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012446 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012447 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012448 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012449 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012450 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012451 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12452 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12453 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012454
12455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200124567.1.1. Matching booleans
12457------------------------
12458
12459In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12460Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12461When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12462that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12463
12464Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12465return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12466"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12467
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200124697.1.2. Matching integers
12470------------------------
12471
12472Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12473enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12474to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12475
12476Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12477matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12478lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012479
12480For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12481unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12482representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12483
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012484As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12485two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12486instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12487ranges and operators.
12488
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012489For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012490operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12491Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12492of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012493
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012494Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012495
12496 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12497 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12498 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12499 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12500 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12501
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012502For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012503
12504 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12505
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012506This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12507
12508 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12509
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200125117.1.3. Matching strings
12512-----------------------
12513
12514String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12515different forms :
12516
12517 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012518 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012519
12520 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012521 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012522
12523 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12524 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12525
12526 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12527 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12528
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012529 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012530 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12531 matches.
12532
12533 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12534 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12535 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012536
12537String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12538exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12539characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12540string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12541to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012542before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012543
12544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200125457.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12546---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012547
12548Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12549they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12550possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12551passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12552the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012553the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12554match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012555
12556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200125577.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12558-------------------------------------
12559
12560It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12561not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12562a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12563to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12564digits may be used upper or lower case.
12565
12566Example :
12567 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12568 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12569
12570
125717.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12572---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012573
12574IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12575netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12576within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012577host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012578difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12579at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12580does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12581parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012582
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012583The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12584abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12585
12586 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12587 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12588 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12589 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12590 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12591 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12592 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12593 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12594
12595Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12596192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12597
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012598IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12599Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12600trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12601IPv6 patterns.
12602
12603HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12604following situations :
12605 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12606 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12607 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12608 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12609 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12610 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12611 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12612 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12613 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12614 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012616
126177.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12618----------------------------------
12619
12620Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12621combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12622
12623 - AND (implicit)
12624 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12625 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012627A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012629 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012631Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12632indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012634For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12635"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12636requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12637is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12638
12639 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012640 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12641 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12642 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012643
12644To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12645and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12646
12647 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12648 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12649 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12650 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12651
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012652 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012653 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12654 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12655 use_backend www if host_www
12656
12657It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12658expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12659be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12660the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12661
12662 The following rule :
12663
12664 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012665 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012666
12667 Can also be written that way :
12668
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012669 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012670
12671It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12672to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12673simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12674sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12675good use is the following :
12676
12677 With named ACLs :
12678
12679 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12680 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12681 monitor fail if site_dead
12682
12683 With anonymous ACLs :
12684
12685 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12686
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012687See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12688keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012689
12690
126917.3. Fetching samples
12692---------------------
12693
12694Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12695against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12696sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12697ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12698of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12699available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12700
12701This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12702Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12703compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12704deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12705
12706The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12707matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12708method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12709indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12710
12711As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12712when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12713mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12714the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12715ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12716
12717Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12718multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12719when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012720incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12721are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012722is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12723all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12724
12725Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12726 - name
12727 - name(arg1)
12728 - name(arg1,arg2)
12729
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012730
127317.3.1. Converters
12732-----------------
12733
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012734Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12735of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12736is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12737was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012738has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012739unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12740
12741These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12742sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12743the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012744support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012745
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012746A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12747support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12748supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12749(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12750bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012752The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012753
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001275451d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12755 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12756 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12757 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12758 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12759 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12760
12761 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012762 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
12763 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000012764 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12765 frontend http-in
12766 bind *:8081
12767 default_backend servers
12768 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12769 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12770
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012771add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012772 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012773 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012774 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12775 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012776 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012777 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12778 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12779 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12780 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012781 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012782 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012783
12784and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012785 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012786 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012787 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12788 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012789 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012790 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12791 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12792 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12793 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012794 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012795 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012796
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020012797b64dec
12798 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
12799 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
12800
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012801base64
12802 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012803 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012804 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12805
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012806bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012807 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012808 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012809 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012810 presence of a flag).
12811
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012812bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12813 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12814 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012815 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012816
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010012817concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
12818 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
12819 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
12820 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
12821 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
12822 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
12823 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
12824 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
12825 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
12826 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
12827 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
12828 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
12829 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
12830 delimitors.
12831
12832 Example:
12833 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
12834 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
12835 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
12836 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
12837
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012838cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012839 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12840 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012841
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012842crc32([<avalanche>])
12843 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12844 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12845 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12846 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12847 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12848 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12849 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12850 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12851 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12852 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010012853 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
12854
12855crc32c([<avalanche>])
12856 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
12857 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12858 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12859 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
12860 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
12861 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
12862 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12863 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012864
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012865da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012866 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12867 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12868 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12869 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012870 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012871 configuration language.
12872
12873 Example:
12874 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012875 bind *:8881
12876 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012877 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012878
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012879debug
12880 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12881 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12882 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12883
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012884div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012885 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12886 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012887 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012888 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12889 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012890 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012891 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12892 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12893 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12894 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012895 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012896 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012897
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012898djb2([<avalanche>])
12899 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12900 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12901 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12902 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12903 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12904 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12905 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010012906 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
12907 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012908
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012909even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012910 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012911 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12912
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020012913field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
12914 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
12915 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
12916 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
12917 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
12918 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
12919 fields.
12920
12921 Example :
12922 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
12923 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
12924 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
12925 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
12926 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012927
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012928hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012929 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012930 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012931 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012932 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012933
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020012934hex2i
12935 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
12936 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
12937
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012938http_date([<offset>])
12939 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12940 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12941 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12942 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12943 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12944 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012945
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012946in_table(<table>)
12947 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12948 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12949 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012950 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012951 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12952
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010012953ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
12954 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012955 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010012956 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
12957 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
12958 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
12959 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
12960 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012961
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012962json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012963 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012964 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012965 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012966 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12967 of errors:
12968 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12969 bytes, ...)
12970 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12971 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12972
12973 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12974 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12975 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12976 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12977 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12978 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012979 - "ascii" : never fails;
12980 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
12981 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012982 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012983 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012984 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12985 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12986
12987 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012988 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012989
12990 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012991 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012992 capture request header user-agent len 150
12993 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012994
12995 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12996 GET / HTTP/1.0
12997 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12998
12999 Output log:
13000 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13001
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013002language(<value>[,<default>])
13003 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13004 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13005 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13006 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13007 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13008 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13009 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13010 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13011 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013012 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013013 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13014 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013015
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013016 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013017
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013018 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13019 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013020
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013021 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13022 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13023 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13024 use_backend spanish if es
13025 use_backend french if fr
13026 use_backend english if en
13027 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013028
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013029length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013030 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13031 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13032 type. The result is of type integer.
13033
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013034lower
13035 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13036 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13037 type. The result is of type string.
13038
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013039ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13040 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13041 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13042 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13043 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13044 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13045 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13046
13047 Example :
13048
13049 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013050 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013051 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13052
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013053map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13054map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13055map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13056 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13057 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13058 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13059 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13060 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13061 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13062 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13063 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013064
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013065 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13066 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13067 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013068
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013069 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013070 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013071
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013072 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13073 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13074 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13075 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013076 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13077 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013078 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13079 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13080 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13081 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13082 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13083 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13084 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13085 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013086 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13087 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13088 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013089 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13090 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13091 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13092 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13093 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013094
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013095 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13096 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13097 the corresponding match text.
13098
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013099 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13100 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13101 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13102 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13103 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013104
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013105 Example :
13106
13107 # this is a comment and is ignored
13108 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13109 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13110 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13111 | | | `---------- value
13112 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13113 | `---------------------------- key
13114 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13115
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013116mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013117 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13118 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013119 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013120 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013121 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013122 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13123 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13124 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13125 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013126 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013127 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013128
13129mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013130 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013131 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13132 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013133 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013134 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013135 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013136 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13137 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13138 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13139 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013140 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013141 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013142
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013143nbsrv
13144 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13145 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13146 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13147 map lookup.
13148
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013149neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013150 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13151 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13152 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13153 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013154
13155not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013156 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013157 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013158 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013159 absence of a flag).
13160
13161odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013162 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013163 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13164
13165or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013166 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013167 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013168 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13169 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013170 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013171 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13172 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13173 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13174 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013175 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013176 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013177
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013178regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013179 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13180 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13181 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13182 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13183 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13184 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13185 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13186 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13187 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13188 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013189 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13190 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13191 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13192 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013193
13194 Example :
13195
13196 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13197 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13198 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13199 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13200
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013201capture-req(<id>)
13202 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13203 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13204
13205 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013206 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13207 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013208
13209capture-res(<id>)
13210 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13211 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13212
13213 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013214 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13215 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013216
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013217sdbm([<avalanche>])
13218 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13219 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13220 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13221 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13222 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13223 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13224 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013225 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13226 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013227
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013228set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013229 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13230 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13231 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013232 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013233 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13234 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013235 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013236 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13237 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013238 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013239 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013240
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013241sha1
13242 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13243 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13244
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013245sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013246 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13247 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013248 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013249 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13250 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013251 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013252 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13253 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013254 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013255 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13256 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013257 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013258 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013259
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013260table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13261 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13262 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13263 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13264 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13265 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13266 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13267
13268
13269table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13270 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13271 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13272 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13273 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13274 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13275 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13276
13277table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13278 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13279 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013280 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013281 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13282 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13283
13284table_conn_cur(<table>)
13285 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13286 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13287 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13288 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13289 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13290
13291table_conn_rate(<table>)
13292 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13293 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13294 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13295 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13296 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13297
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013298table_gpt0(<table>)
13299 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13300 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13301 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13302 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13303 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13304
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013305table_gpc0(<table>)
13306 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13307 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13308 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13309 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13310 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13311
13312table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13313 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13314 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13315 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13316 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13317 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13318 sample fetch keyword.
13319
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013320table_gpc1(<table>)
13321 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13322 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13323 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13324 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13325 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13326
13327table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13328 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13329 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13330 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13331 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13332 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13333 sample fetch keyword.
13334
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013335table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13336 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13337 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013338 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013339 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13340 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13341
13342table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13343 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13344 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13345 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13346 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13347 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13348 keyword.
13349
13350table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13351 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13352 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013353 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013354 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13355 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13356
13357table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13358 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13359 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13360 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13361 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13362 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13363 keyword.
13364
13365table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13366 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13367 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013368 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013369 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13370 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13371 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13372 keyword.
13373
13374table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13375 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13376 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013377 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013378 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13379 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13380 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13381 keyword.
13382
13383table_server_id(<table>)
13384 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13385 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13386 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13387 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13388 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13389 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13390
13391table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13392 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13393 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013394 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013395 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13396 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13397 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13398 keyword.
13399
13400table_sess_rate(<table>)
13401 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13402 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13403 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13404 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13405 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13406 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13407 keyword.
13408
13409table_trackers(<table>)
13410 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13411 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13412 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13413 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13414 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13415 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13416 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13417 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13418 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13419 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13420
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013421upper
13422 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13423 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13424 type. The result is of type string.
13425
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013426url_dec
13427 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13428 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13429
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013430unset-var(<var name>)
13431 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13432 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13433 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13434 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13435 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13436 response),
13437 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13438 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13439 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13440 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13441
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013442utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13443 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13444 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13445 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13446 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13447 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13448 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13449
13450 Example :
13451
13452 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013453 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013454 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13455
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013456word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13457 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13458 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13459 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13460 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13461 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13462
13463 Example :
13464 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13465 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13466 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13467 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13468 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013469
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013470wt6([<avalanche>])
13471 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13472 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13473 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13474 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13475 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13476 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13477 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013478 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
13479 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013480
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013481xor(<value>)
13482 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013483 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013484 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013485 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013486 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013487 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13488 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013489 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013490 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13491 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013492 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013493 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013494
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013495xxh32([<seed>])
13496 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13497 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13498 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13499 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13500 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13501 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13502 as cryptographically secure.
13503
13504xxh64([<seed>])
13505 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13506 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13507 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13508 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13509 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13510 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13511 as cryptographically secure.
13512
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013513
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200135147.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013515--------------------------------------------
13516
13517A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13518not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13519"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13520The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13521
13522always_false : boolean
13523 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13524 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13525
13526always_true : boolean
13527 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13528 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13529
13530avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013531 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013532 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13533 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13534 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13535 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13536 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13537 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13538 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13539 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13540 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13541 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13542 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13543 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13544 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013546be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013547 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13548 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13549 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13550 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
13551 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013553be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13554 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13555 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13556 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013557 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013558 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13559 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013560
13561 Example :
13562 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13563 backend dynamic
13564 mode http
13565 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13566 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013567
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013568bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013569 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13570 of the string.
13571
13572bool(<bool>) : bool
13573 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13574 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013576connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13577 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013578 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013579 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13580 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013581
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013582 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013583 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013584 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13585
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013586 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13587 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013588
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013589 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013590 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013591 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013592 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013593 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013594 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013595 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013596
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013597 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13598 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013599 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013600 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013601
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013602date([<offset>]) : integer
13603 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13604 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13605 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13606 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013607 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13608
13609 Example :
13610
13611 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13612 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013613
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010013614date_us : integer
13615 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
13616 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
13617 from the same timeval structure.
13618
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020013619distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
13620 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
13621 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
13622 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
13623 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
13624 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
13625 list of supported tokens.
13626
13627distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
13628 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
13629 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
13630 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
13631 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
13632 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
13633 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
13634 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
13635 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
13636 supported tokens.
13637
13638 Example :
13639 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
13640 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
13641 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
13642 # send large files to the big farm
13643 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
13644
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013645env(<name>) : string
13646 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13647 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13648 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13649 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13650 certain way.
13651
13652 Examples :
13653 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13654 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13655
13656 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13657 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013659fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13660 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013661 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13662 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013663 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13664 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013665 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013666 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13667 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013668
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013669fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13670 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13671 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13672 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013674fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13675 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13676 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13677 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13678 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13679 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13680 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13681 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13682 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013683
13684 Example :
13685 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13686 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13687 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13688 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13689 frontend mail
13690 bind :25
13691 mode tcp
13692 maxconn 100
13693 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13694 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13695 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13696 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013697
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013698hostname : string
13699 Returns the system hostname.
13700
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013701int(<integer>) : signed integer
13702 Returns a signed integer.
13703
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013704ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13705 Returns an ipv4.
13706
13707ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13708 Returns an ipv6.
13709
13710meth(<method>) : method
13711 Returns a method.
13712
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013713nbproc : integer
13714 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13715 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13716 and debugging purposes.
13717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013718nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13719 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13720 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13721 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013722 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13723 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13724 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013725
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013726proc : integer
13727 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13728 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13729 debugging purposes.
13730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013731queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013732 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13733 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13734 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013735 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13736 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13737 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13738 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13739 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13740
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013741rand([<range>]) : integer
13742 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13743 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13744 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13745 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13746 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013748srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13749 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13750 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13751 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13752 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13753 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13754 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13755 methods.
13756
13757srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13758 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13759 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13760 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013761 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013762 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13763 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13764 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13765
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020013766srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13767 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
13768 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
13769 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
13770 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
13771 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
13772 fetch methods.
13773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013774srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13775 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13776 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013777 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013778 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13779 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013780 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013781 overloading servers).
13782
13783 Example :
13784 # Redirect to a separate back
13785 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13786 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13787 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13788
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013789stopping : boolean
13790 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13791 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13792 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13793
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013794str(<string>) : string
13795 Returns a string.
13796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013797table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13798 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13799 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13800
13801table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13802 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13803 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13804 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13805
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010013806thread : integer
13807 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
13808 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
13809 and debugging purposes.
13810
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013811var(<var-name>) : undefined
13812 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013813 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13814 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013815 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013816 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13817 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013818 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013819 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13820 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013821 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013822 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013823
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200138247.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013825----------------------------------
13826
13827The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13828closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13829methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13830sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13831TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013832the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13833counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13834"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013835argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13836the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13837this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013838
13839be_id : integer
13840 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13841 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13842
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013843be_name : string
13844 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13845 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013847dst : ip
13848 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13849 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13850 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13851 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13852 RFC 4291.
13853
13854dst_conn : integer
13855 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13856 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13857 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13858 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13859 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13860 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13861 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13862 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013863
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013864dst_is_local : boolean
13865 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13866 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13867 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13868 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013869 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013870 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13871 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13872 it only once per connection.
13873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013874dst_port : integer
13875 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13876 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13877 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13878 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13879 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13880 an HTTP header.
13881
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020013882fc_http_major : integer
13883 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
13884 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
13885 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
13886
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013887fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13888 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13889 header.
13890
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013891fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13892 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13893 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13894 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13895 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13896 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13897 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13898
13899fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13900 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13901 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13902 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13903 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13904 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13905 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13906
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013907fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13908 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13909 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13910 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13911 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13912
13913fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13914 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13915 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13916 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13917 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13918
13919fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13920 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13921 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13922 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13923 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13924
13925fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13926 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13927 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13928 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13929 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13930
13931fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13932 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13933 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13934 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13935 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13936
13937fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13938 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13939 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13940 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13941 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13942
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020013943fe_defbe : string
13944 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
13945 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
13946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013947fe_id : integer
13948 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013949 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013950 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13951
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013952fe_name : string
13953 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13954 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13955 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13956
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013957sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013958sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13959sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13960sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013961 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13962 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13963 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13964
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013965sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013966sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13967sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13968sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013969 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13970 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13971 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13972
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013973sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013974sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13975sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13976sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013977 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13978 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013979 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13980 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13981 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013982
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013983 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013984 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13985 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013986 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13987 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13988 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013989 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13990 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13991
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013992sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13993sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
13994sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
13995sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
13996 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13997 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
13998 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13999 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14000 when a first ACL was verified.
14001
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014002sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014003sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14004sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14005sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014006 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014007 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14008
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014009sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014010sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14011sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14012sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014013 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14014 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14015 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14016
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014017sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014018sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14019sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14020sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014021 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14022 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14023 See also src_conn_rate.
14024
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014025sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014026sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14027sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14028sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014029 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014030 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014031
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014032sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14033sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14034sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14035sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14036 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14037 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14038
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014039sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14040sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14041sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14042sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14043 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14044 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14045
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014046sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014047sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14048sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14049sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014050 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14051 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14052 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014053 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14054 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14055 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014056
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014057sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14058sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14059sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14060sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14061 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14062 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14063 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14064 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14065 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14066 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14067
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014068sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014069sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14070sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14071sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014072 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014073 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14074 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14075
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014076sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014077sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14078sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14079sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014080 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14081 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14082 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14083 src_http_err_rate.
14084
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014085sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014086sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14087sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14088sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014089 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014090 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14091 src_http_req_cnt.
14092
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014093sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014094sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14095sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14096sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014097 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14098 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14099 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14100 src_http_req_rate.
14101
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014102sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014103sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14104sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14105sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014106 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014107 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14108 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14109 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14110 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014111
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014112 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014113 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14114 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014115 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14116
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014117sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14118sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14119sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14120sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14121 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14122 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14123 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14124 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14125 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14126
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014127sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014128sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14129sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14130sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014131 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14132 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14133 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014134
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014135sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014136sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14137sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14138sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014139 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14140 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14141 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014142
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014143sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014144sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14145sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14146sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014147 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014148 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14149 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14150 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014151 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014152 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14153
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014154sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014155sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14156sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14157sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014158 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14159 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14160 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14161 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14162 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014163 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014164
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014165sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014166sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14167sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14168sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014169 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14170 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14171 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14172
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014173sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014174sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14175sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14176sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014177 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14178 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014179 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014180 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14181 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014182 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14183 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14184 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014186so_id : integer
14187 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14188 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14189 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014191src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014192 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014193 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14194 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14195 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014196 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14197 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14198 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
14199 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014200
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014201 Example:
14202 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14203 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014205src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14206 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14207 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14208 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014209 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014211src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14212 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14213 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014214 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014215 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014217src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14218 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14219 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14220 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14221 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14222 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14223 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014224
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014225 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014226 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14227 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14228 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14229 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014230 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014231 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14232 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14233
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014234src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14235 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14236 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14237 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14238 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14239 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14240 was verified.
14241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014242src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014243 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014244 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014245 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014246 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014248src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014249 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014250 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14251 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014252 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014254src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14255 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14256 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14257 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014258 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014260src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014261 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014262 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014263 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014264 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014265
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014266src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14267 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14268 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14269 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14270 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14271
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014272src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14273 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14274 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14275 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14276 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014278src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014279 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014280 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014281 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14282 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014283 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14284 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14285 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014286
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014287src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14288 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14289 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14290 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14291 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14292 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14293 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14294 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014296src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014297 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014298 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014299 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014300 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014301 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014303src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14304 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14305 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14306 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14307 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014308 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014310src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014311 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014312 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14313 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014314 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014316src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14317 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14318 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14319 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014320 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014321 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014323src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14324 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14325 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14326 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014327 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014328 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14329 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014330
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014331 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014332 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014333 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014334 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014335
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014336src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14337 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14338 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14339 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
14340 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14341 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14342 connection when a first ACL was verified.
14343
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014344src_is_local : boolean
14345 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14346 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14347 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14348 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014349 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014350 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14351 once per connection.
14352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014353src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014354 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14355 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14356 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14357 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14358 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014360src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014361 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14362 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14363 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14364 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14365 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014367src_port : integer
14368 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14369 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14370 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14371 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014373src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014374 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014375 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14376 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14377 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014378 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014380src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14381 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14382 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14383 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14384 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014385 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014387src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14388 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
14389 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
14390 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
14391 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
14392 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
14393 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
14394 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
14395 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014396
14397 Example :
14398 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
14399 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
14400 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
14401 listen ssh
14402 bind :22
14403 mode tcp
14404 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014405 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014406 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014407 server local 127.0.0.1:22
14408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014409srv_id : integer
14410 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
14411 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
14412 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020014413
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144147.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014415----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020014416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014417The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
14418closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
14419when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
14420usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014421future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014422
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001442351d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
14424 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14425 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14426 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
14427 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14428 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14429
14430 Example :
14431 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
14432 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
14433 # the request.
14434 frontend http-in
14435 bind *:8081
14436 default_backend servers
14437 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14438 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14439
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014440ssl_bc : boolean
14441 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14442 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
14443 other a server with the "ssl" option.
14444
14445ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
14446 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
14447 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14448
14449ssl_bc_cipher : string
14450 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
14451 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14452
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010014453ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
14454 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14455 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
14456 session or a TLS ticket.
14457
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014458ssl_bc_protocol : string
14459 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
14460 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14461
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014462ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014463 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014464 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14465 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014466
14467ssl_bc_session_id : binary
14468 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
14469 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
14470 if session was reused or not.
14471
14472ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
14473 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
14474 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014476ssl_c_ca_err : integer
14477 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14478 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
14479 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
14480 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
14481 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014483ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
14484 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14485 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
14486 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
14487 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014488
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014489ssl_c_der : binary
14490 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
14491 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14492 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014494ssl_c_err : integer
14495 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14496 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
14497 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
14498 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
14499 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014501ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14502 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14503 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14504 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14505 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14506 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14507 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14508 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14509 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014511ssl_c_key_alg : string
14512 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14513 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14514 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014516ssl_c_notafter : string
14517 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
14518 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14519 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014521ssl_c_notbefore : string
14522 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
14523 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14524 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014526ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14527 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14528 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14529 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14530 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14531 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14532 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14533 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14534 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014536ssl_c_serial : binary
14537 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
14538 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14539 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014541ssl_c_sha1 : binary
14542 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
14543 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
14544 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014545 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
14546 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
14547
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014548 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014549 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014551ssl_c_sig_alg : string
14552 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14553 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14554 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014556ssl_c_used : boolean
14557 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
14558 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014560ssl_c_verify : integer
14561 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
14562 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
14563 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
14564 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014566ssl_c_version : integer
14567 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
14568 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014569
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014570ssl_f_der : binary
14571 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
14572 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14573 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014575ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14576 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14577 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14578 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14579 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014580 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014581 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14582 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14583 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014585ssl_f_key_alg : string
14586 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14587 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
14588 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014590ssl_f_notafter : string
14591 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14592 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14593 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014595ssl_f_notbefore : string
14596 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14597 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14598 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014600ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14601 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14602 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14603 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14604 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14605 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14606 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14607 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14608 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014610ssl_f_serial : binary
14611 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14612 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14613 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014614
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020014615ssl_f_sha1 : binary
14616 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
14617 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
14618 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
14619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014620ssl_f_sig_alg : string
14621 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14622 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14623 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014625ssl_f_version : integer
14626 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14627 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14628
14629ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014630 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14631 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
14632 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
14633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014634 Example :
14635 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
14636 listen http-https
14637 bind :80
14638 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
14639 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
14640
14641ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
14642 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
14643 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14644
14645ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014646 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014647 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
14648 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
14649 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14650 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14651 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
14652 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
14653 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14654 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
14655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014656ssl_fc_cipher : string
14657 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
14658 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014659
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014660ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
14661 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
14662 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014663 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014664
14665ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
14666 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
14667 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014668 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014669
14670ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
14671 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
14672 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
14673 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014674 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020014675 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014676
14677ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
14678 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
14679 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014680 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014682ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014683 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
14684 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010014685 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
14686 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
14687 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
14688 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014689
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020014690ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
14691 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
14692 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
14693 wait until the handshake happened.
14694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014695ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
14696 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020014697 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
14698 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
14699 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14700 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014701
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020014702ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014703 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010014704 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
14705 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014707ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014708 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014709 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
14710 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
14711 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14712 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
14713 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
14714 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
14715 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020014716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014717ssl_fc_protocol : string
14718 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
14719 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014720
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014721ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014722 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014723 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14724 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014726ssl_fc_session_id : binary
14727 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
14728 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
14729 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
14730 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014732ssl_fc_sni : string
14733 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
14734 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
14735 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
14736 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
14737 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
14738
14739 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
14740 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
14741 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020014742 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
14743 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014745 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014746 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
14747 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020014748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014749ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
14750 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
14751 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014752
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014753
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200147547.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014755------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014757Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
14758sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
14759only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
14760For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
14761be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
14762can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
14763sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
14764for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
14765content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014767payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014768 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014769 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
14770 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014772payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
14773 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014774 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014775 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014776
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020014777req.hdrs : string
14778 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
14779 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
14780 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
14781 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
14782
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020014783req.hdrs_bin : binary
14784 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
14785 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
14786 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
14787 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
14788 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
14789 names and values (length of 0 for both).
14790
14791 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
14792
14793 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
14794 str: <int:length><bytes>
14795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014796req.len : integer
14797req_len : integer (deprecated)
14798 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14799 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14800 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14801 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14802 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14803 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14804 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
14805 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014807req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14808 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014809 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14810 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14811 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14812 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014814 ACL alternatives :
14815 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014817req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14818 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14819 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14820 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
14821 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014823 ACL alternatives :
14824 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014826 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014828req.proto_http : boolean
14829req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
14830 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
14831 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
14832 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
14833 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
14834 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
14835 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
14836 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014838 Example:
14839 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
14840 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14841 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014842 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014844req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
14845rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14846 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
14847 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
14848 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
14849 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
14850 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
14851 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
14852 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014854 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
14855 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
14856 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
14857 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
14858 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
14859 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014861 ACL derivatives :
14862 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014864 Example :
14865 listen tse-farm
14866 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14867 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14868 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14869 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14870 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14871 persist rdp-cookie
14872 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14873 # This is only useful makes sense if
14874 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14875 stick-table type string size 204800
14876 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14877 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14878 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014880 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14881 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014883req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14884rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14885 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14886 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14887 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14888 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014890 ACL derivatives :
14891 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014892
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014893req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14894 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14895 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014896 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14897 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14898 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14899 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14900 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014902req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14903req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14904 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14905 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14906 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14907 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14908 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14909 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14910 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014912req.ssl_sni : string
14913req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14914 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14915 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14916 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14917 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14918 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14919 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14920 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14921 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14922 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14923 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14924 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14925 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014927 ACL derivatives :
14928 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014930 Examples :
14931 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14932 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14933 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14934 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14935 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014936
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014937req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14938 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14939 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14940 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14941 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14942 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14943 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14944 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14945 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14946 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014948req.ssl_ver : integer
14949req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14950 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14951 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14952 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14953 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14954 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14955 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14956 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014957 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014958 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014960 ACL derivatives :
14961 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014962
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020014963res.len : integer
14964 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14965 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14966 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14967 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14968 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14969 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14970 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
14971 content inspection.
14972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014973res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14974 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014975 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14976 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14977 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14978 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014980res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14981 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14982 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14983 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
14984 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014986 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014987
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020014988res.ssl_hello_type : integer
14989rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14990 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14991 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
14992 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14993 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14994 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
14995 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14996 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
14997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014998wait_end : boolean
14999 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15000 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015001 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015002 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15003 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015004 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015005 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15006 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015008 Examples :
15009 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15010 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15011 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015013 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15014 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15015 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15016 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15017 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15018 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15019 tcp-request content reject
15020
15021
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200150227.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015023--------------------------------------
15024
15025It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15026This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15027data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15028its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15029HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15030content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15031to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15032more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15033response are indexed.
15034
15035base : string
15036 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15037 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15038 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15039 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15040 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15041 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15042 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15043 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15044
15045 ACL derivatives :
15046 base : exact string match
15047 base_beg : prefix match
15048 base_dir : subdir match
15049 base_dom : domain match
15050 base_end : suffix match
15051 base_len : length match
15052 base_reg : regex match
15053 base_sub : substring match
15054
15055base32 : integer
15056 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15057 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15058 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015059 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15060 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15061 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015062
15063base32+src : binary
15064 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15065 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15066 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15067 per-URL counters.
15068
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015069capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15070 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15071 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15072 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15073
15074capture.req.method : string
15075 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15076 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15077 because it's allocated.
15078
15079capture.req.uri : string
15080 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15081 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15082 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15083 allocated.
15084
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015085capture.req.ver : string
15086 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15087 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15088 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15089
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015090capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15091 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15092 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15093 The first entry is an index of 0.
15094 See also: "capture response header"
15095
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015096capture.res.ver : string
15097 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15098 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15099 persistent flag.
15100
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015101req.body : binary
15102 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15103 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15104 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15105 the first chunk is analyzed.
15106
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015107req.body_param([<name>) : string
15108 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15109 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15110 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15111 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15112 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15113 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15114 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15115 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15116 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15117 given.
15118
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015119req.body_len : integer
15120 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15121 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15122 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15123 "option http-buffer-request".
15124
15125req.body_size : integer
15126 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15127 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15128 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15129 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15130 "option http-buffer-request".
15131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015132req.cook([<name>]) : string
15133cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15134 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15135 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15136 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15137 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15138 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15139 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15140 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15141 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15142
15143 ACL derivatives :
15144 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15145 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15146 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15147 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15148 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15149 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15150 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15151 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015153req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15154cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15155 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15156 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015158req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15159cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15160 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15161 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15162 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15163 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015165cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15166 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15167 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15168 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15169 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015170 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015171 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15172 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15173 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15174 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015176hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15177 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15178 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15179 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15180 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015181 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015183req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15184 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15185 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15186 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15187 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15188 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15189 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15190 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15191 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015193req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15194 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15195 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15196 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15197 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015199req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15200 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15201 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15202 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15203 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15204 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15205 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15206 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15207 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015208 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015209 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015210 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015212 ACL derivatives :
15213 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15214 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15215 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15216 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15217 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15218 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15219 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15220 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15221
15222req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15223hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15224 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15225 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15226 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15227 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15228 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15229 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15230 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15231 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15232 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15233
15234req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15235hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15236 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15237 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15238 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15239 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15240 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015241 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015242 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15243 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15244
15245req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15246hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15247 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15248 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15249 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15250 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15251 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15252 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15253 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15254
15255http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15256 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15257 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15258 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15259 basic auth is supported.
15260
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015261http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15262 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15263 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15264 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15265 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015266 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15267 basic auth is supported.
15268
15269 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015270 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
15271 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
15272 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
15273 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015274
15275http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015276 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
15277 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015278 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
15279 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015281method : integer + string
15282 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
15283 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
15284 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
15285 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
15286 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
15287 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
15288 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015290 ACL derivatives :
15291 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015293 Example :
15294 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
15295 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
15296 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015298path : string
15299 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
15300 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
15301 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
15302 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
15303 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015304 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015305 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015307 ACL derivatives :
15308 path : exact string match
15309 path_beg : prefix match
15310 path_dir : subdir match
15311 path_dom : domain match
15312 path_end : suffix match
15313 path_len : length match
15314 path_reg : regex match
15315 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015316
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015317query : string
15318 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
15319 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
15320 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
15321 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015322 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015323 which stops before the question mark.
15324
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015325req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15326 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15327 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15328 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15329 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015331req.ver : string
15332req_ver : string (deprecated)
15333 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
15334 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
15335 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015337 ACL derivatives :
15338 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015340res.comp : boolean
15341 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
15342 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
15343 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015345res.comp_algo : string
15346 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
15347 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
15348 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015350res.cook([<name>]) : string
15351scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15352 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15353 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15354 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015356 ACL derivatives :
15357 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015359res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15360scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15361 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15362 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
15363 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015365res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15366scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15367 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15368 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
15369 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015371res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15372 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15373 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15374 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15375 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15376 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
15377 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
15378 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
15379 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
15380 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015382res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15383 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15384 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15385 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15386 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
15387 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015389res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15390shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
15391 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15392 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15393 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15394 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15395 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
15396 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
15397 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
15398 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015400 ACL derivatives :
15401 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15402 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15403 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15404 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15405 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15406 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15407 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15408 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15409
15410res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15411shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15412 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15413 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15414 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
15415 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
15416 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015418res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15419shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15420 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
15421 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
15422 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
15423 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
15424 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
15425 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015426
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015427res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15428 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15429 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15430 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15431 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015433res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15434shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15435 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
15436 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15437 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
15438 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
15439 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
15440 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015442res.ver : string
15443resp_ver : string (deprecated)
15444 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
15445 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015447 ACL derivatives :
15448 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015450set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15451 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15452 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015453 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015454 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015456 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
15457 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015459status : integer
15460 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
15461 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
15462 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015463
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020015464unique-id : string
15465 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
15466 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
15467 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
15468 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
15469 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
15470 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
15471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015472url : string
15473 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
15474 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
15475 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
15476 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
15477 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
15478 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
15479 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015481 ACL derivatives :
15482 url : exact string match
15483 url_beg : prefix match
15484 url_dir : subdir match
15485 url_dom : domain match
15486 url_end : suffix match
15487 url_len : length match
15488 url_reg : regex match
15489 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015491url_ip : ip
15492 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
15493 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
15494 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
15495 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
15496 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
15497 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15498 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015500url_port : integer
15501 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
15502 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
15503 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15504 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015505
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015506urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
15507url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015508 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
15509 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015510 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
15511 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
15512 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
15513 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015514 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
15515 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015516 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
15517 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015519 ACL derivatives :
15520 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
15521 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
15522 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
15523 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
15524 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
15525 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
15526 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
15527 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015528
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015530 Example :
15531 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
15532 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
15533 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
15534 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015535
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015536urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015537 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
15538 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
15539 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020015540
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020015541url32 : integer
15542 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
15543 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
15544 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
15545 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
15546 is an unsigned integer.
15547
15548url32+src : binary
15549 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
15550 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
15551 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
15552
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010015553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155547.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015555---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015556
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015557Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
15558every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020015559order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015560
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015561ACL name Equivalent to Usage
15562---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015563FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020015564HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015565HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
15566HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015567HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
15568HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
15569HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
15570HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
15571LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015572METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015573METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015574METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
15575METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
15576METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
15577METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015578METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015579METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015580RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015581REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015582TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015583WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
15584---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015585
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010015586
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155878. Logging
15588----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015589
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015590One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
15591provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
15592very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
15593provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
15594state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015595to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015596headers.
15597
15598In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
15599about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
15600send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
15601
15602 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
15603 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
15604 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
15605 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
15606 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015607 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060015608 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015609
15610The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
15611allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
15612as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
15613while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
15614real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
15615delay.
15616
15617
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156188.1. Log levels
15619---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015620
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015621TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015622source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015623HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
15624in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
15625track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
15626syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
15627about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015628
15629
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156308.2. Log formats
15631----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015632
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015633HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015634and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
15635slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
15636options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015637
15638 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
15639 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
15640 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
15641 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
15642 extents.
15643
15644 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
15645 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
15646 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
15647 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
15648 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
15649
15650 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
15651 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
15652 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
15653 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
15654 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
15655
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020015656 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
15657 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
15658 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
15659 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
15660
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015661 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
15662
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015663Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
15664specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
15665field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
15666servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
15667always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
15668identifier.
15669
15670Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
15671 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
15672 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
15673 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
15674 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
15675
15676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156778.2.1. Default log format
15678-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015679
15680This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
15681as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
15682format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
15683
15684 Example :
15685 listen www
15686 mode http
15687 log global
15688 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15689
15690 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
15691 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
15692 (www/HTTP)
15693
15694 Field Format Extract from the example above
15695 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
15696 2 'Connect from' Connect from
15697 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
15698 4 'to' to
15699 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
15700 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
15701
15702Detailed fields description :
15703 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
15704 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
15705 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
15706 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
15707 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15708 and processed the connection.
15709 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
15710
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015711In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
15712"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
15713connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
15714
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015715It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
15716will eventually disappear.
15717
15718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157198.2.2. TCP log format
15720---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015721
15722The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
15723is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
15724information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
15725counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
15726emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
15727environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
15728the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
15729sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015730specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
15731not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
15732fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
15733marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015734
15735 Example :
15736 frontend fnt
15737 mode tcp
15738 option tcplog
15739 log global
15740 default_backend bck
15741
15742 backend bck
15743 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15744
15745 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
15746 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
15747 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
15748
15749 Field Format Extract from the example above
15750 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
15751 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
15752 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
15753 4 frontend_name fnt
15754 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
15755 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
15756 7 bytes_read* 212
15757 8 termination_state --
15758 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
15759 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15760
15761Detailed fields description :
15762 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015763 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15764 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15765 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015766 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015767 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015768 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015769
15770 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015771 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15772 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15773 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015774
15775 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
15776 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
15777 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
15778 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
15779
15780 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15781 and processed the connection.
15782
15783 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15784 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15785 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
15786 applications.
15787
15788 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15789 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15790 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15791 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
15792 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
15793
15794 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15795 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15796 See "Timers" below for more details.
15797
15798 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15799 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15800 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
15801 "Timers" below for more details.
15802
15803 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015804 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015805 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
15806 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
15807 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
15808 details.
15809
15810 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
15811 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
15812 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
15813 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
15814 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
15815
15816 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15817 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15818 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
15819 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
15820 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
15821 for more details.
15822
15823 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015824 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015825 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
15826 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
15827 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015828 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015829
15830 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15831 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15832 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15833 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15834 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15835 caused by a denial of service attack.
15836
15837 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15838 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15839 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15840 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15841 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15842 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15843 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15844 denial of service attack.
15845
15846 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15847 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15848 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15849 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15850 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15851 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15852 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15853 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
15854 be processed than on other servers.
15855
15856 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15857 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15858 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15859 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15860 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15861 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15862 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15863 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15864 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15865 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15866 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15867 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15868 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15869
15870 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15871 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15872 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15873 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15874 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15875 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015876 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015877 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15878
15879 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15880 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15881 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15882 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15883 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15884 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015885 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015886 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15887 occurs.
15888
15889
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158908.2.3. HTTP log format
15891----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015892
15893The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15894is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15895the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15896are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15897emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15898generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15899"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15900which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015901frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15902is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015903
15904Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15905slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15906with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15907
15908 Example :
15909 frontend http-in
15910 mode http
15911 option httplog
15912 log global
15913 default_backend bck
15914
15915 backend static
15916 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15917
15918 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15919 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15920 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015921 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015922
15923 Field Format Extract from the example above
15924 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15925 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015926 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015927 4 frontend_name http-in
15928 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015929 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015930 7 status_code 200
15931 8 bytes_read* 2750
15932 9 captured_request_cookie -
15933 10 captured_response_cookie -
15934 11 termination_state ----
15935 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15936 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15937 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15938 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15939 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015940
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015941Detailed fields description :
15942 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015943 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15944 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15945 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015946 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015947 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015948 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015949
15950 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015951 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15952 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15953 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015954
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015955 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15956 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015957
15958 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15959 and processed the connection.
15960
15961 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15962 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15963 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
15964
15965 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15966 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15967 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15968 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
15969 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
15970 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
15971
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015972 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
15973 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
15974 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
15975 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
15976 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
15977 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
15978 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015979
15980 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15981 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15982 See "Timers" below for more details.
15983
15984 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15985 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15986 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
15987 below for more details.
15988
15989 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
15990 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
15991 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
15992 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
15993 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
15994 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
15995 for more details.
15996
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015997 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
15998 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
15999 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16000 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16001 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16002 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16003 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
16004 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016005
16006 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16007 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16008 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16009
16010 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16011 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
16012 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
16013 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16014 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16015 overflowing.
16016
16017 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16018 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16019 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16020 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16021 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16022 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16023 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16024 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16025
16026 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16027 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16028 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16029 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16030 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16031 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16032 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16033 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16034
16035 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16036 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16037 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16038 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16039 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16040 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16041 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16042
16043 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016044 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016045 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16046 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16047 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016048 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016049 system.
16050
16051 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16052 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16053 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16054 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16055 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16056 caused by a denial of service attack.
16057
16058 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16059 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16060 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16061 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16062 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16063 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16064 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16065 denial of service attack.
16066
16067 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16068 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16069 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16070 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16071 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16072 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16073 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16074 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16075 processed than on other servers.
16076
16077 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16078 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16079 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16080 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16081 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16082 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16083 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16084 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16085 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16086 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16087 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16088 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16089 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16090
16091 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16092 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16093 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16094 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16095 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16096 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016097 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016098 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16099
16100 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16101 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16102 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16103 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16104 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16105 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016106 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016107 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16108 occurs.
16109
16110 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16111 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16112 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16113 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16114 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16115 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16116 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16117 cookies" below for more details.
16118
16119 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16120 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16121 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16122 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16123 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16124 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16125 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16126 and cookies" below for more details.
16127
16128 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16129 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16130 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16131 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16132 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16133 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16134 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16135 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16136
16137
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200161388.2.4. Custom log format
16139------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016140
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016141The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016142mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016143
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016144HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016145Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16146separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16147prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16148
16149Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16150variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016151("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016152
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016153If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016154as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016155less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16156the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16157
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016158Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016159In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016160in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016161
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016162Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16163'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16164https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16165such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16166
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016167Flags are :
16168 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016169 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016170 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16171 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016172
16173 Example:
16174
16175 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16176 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16177
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016178 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16179
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016180At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16181
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016182 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16183 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016184
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016185the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016186
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016187 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16188 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16189 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016190
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016191and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16192
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016193 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16194 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016195
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016196Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16197
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016198 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016199 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016200 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16201 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16202 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016203 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16204 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16205 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016206 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016207 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16208 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016209 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016210 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16211 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016212 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016213 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016214 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016215 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016216 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016217 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016218 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016219 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16220 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16221 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16222 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16223 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016224 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016225 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16226 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016227 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016228 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16229 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016230 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16231 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16232 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016233 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016234 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16235 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016236 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016237 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16238 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16239 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016240 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016241 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016242 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16243 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16244 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16245 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016246 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016247 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016248 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016249 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016250 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016251 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016252 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16253 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16254 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016255 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016256 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16257 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016258 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016259 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16260 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
16261 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016262 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016263 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016264 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016265
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016266 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016267
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016268
162698.2.5. Error log format
16270-----------------------
16271
16272When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
16273protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
16274By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
16275"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016276will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016277logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
16278
16279The format looks like this :
16280
16281 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
16282 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
16283 Connection error during SSL handshake
16284
16285 Field Format Extract from the example above
16286 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
16287 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
16288 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
16289 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
16290 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
16291
16292These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
16293failures.
16294
16295
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162968.3. Advanced logging options
16297-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016298
16299Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
16300just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
16301options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
16302for more information about their usage.
16303
16304
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
16306------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016307
16308It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
16309haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
16310commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
16311monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
16312ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
16313
16314 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
16315 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
16316 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
16317 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
16318
16319 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
16320 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
16321 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016322 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016323 such as other load-balancers.
16324
16325 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
16326 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
16327 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
16328
16329
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163308.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
16331----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016332
16333The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
16334what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
16335or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016336"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016337just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
16338log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
16339after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
16340is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
16341with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
16342with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
16343
16344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163458.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
16346------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016347
16348Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
16349for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
16350"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
16351retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
16352raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
16353a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
16354file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
16355you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
16356"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
16357
16358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163598.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
16360--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016361
16362Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
16363multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
16364them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
16365"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
16366logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
16367error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
16368and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
16369too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
16370useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
16371alternative.
16372
16373
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163748.4. Timing events
16375------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016376
16377Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
16378reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
16379the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
16380frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016381mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
16382addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
16383
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010016384Timings events in HTTP mode:
16385
16386 first request 2nd request
16387 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
16388 t tr t tr ...
16389 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
16390 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
16391 :<---- Tq ---->: :
16392 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
16393 :<--------- Ta --------->:
16394
16395Timings events in TCP mode:
16396
16397 TCP session
16398 |<----------------->|
16399 t t
16400 ---|----|----|----|----|---
16401 | Th Tw Tc Td |
16402 |<------ Tt ------->|
16403
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016404 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016405 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016406 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
16407 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
16408 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016409 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016410 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016411
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016412 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
16413 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
16414 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
16415 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
16416 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
16417 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
16418 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
16419 nothing was received on the connection.
16420
16421 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
16422 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
16423 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
16424 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
16425 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
16426 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
16427 request typed by hand during a test.
16428
16429 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
16430 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016431 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016432 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
16433 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
16434 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
16435 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016436
16437 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
16438 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
16439 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
16440 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
16441 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
16442
16443 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
16444 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
16445 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
16446 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
16447 connection never established.
16448
16449 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
16450 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
16451 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
16452 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
16453 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
16454 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
16455 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
16456 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
16457 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
16458 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
16459 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
16460
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016461 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
16462 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
16463 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
16464 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
16465 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
16466 by subtracting other timers when valid :
16467
16468 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
16469
16470 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
16471 "Ta" can never be negative.
16472
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016473 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
16474 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016475 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
16476 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016477 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016478
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016479 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016480
16481 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016482 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
16483 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016484
16485These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
16486protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
16487that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016488due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
16489"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
16490that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016491
16492Most common cases :
16493
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016494 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
16495 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
16496 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
16497 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
16498 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
16499 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
16500 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
16501 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
16502 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
16503 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
16504 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020016505 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016506
16507 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
16508 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
16509 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
16510 of ms on remote networks.
16511
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016512 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
16513 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
16514 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016515
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016516 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
16517 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
16518 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
16519 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
16520 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
16521 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
16522 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
16523 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
16524 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016525
16526Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
16527
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016528 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016529 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016530 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016531
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016532 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016533 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
16534 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
16535
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016536 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016537 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
16538 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
16539 flags.
16540
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016541 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
16542 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016543 Check the session termination flags, then check the
16544 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
16545 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
16546 the client connection was maintained open.
16547
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016548 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016549 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016550 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016551 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
16552
16553
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165548.5. Session state at disconnection
16555-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016556
16557TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
16558"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
165592-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
16560each of which has a special meaning :
16561
16562 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
16563 session to terminate :
16564
16565 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
16566
16567 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
16568 server explicitly refused it.
16569
16570 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
16571 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
16572 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
16573 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016574 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016575
16576 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
16577 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016578
16579 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
16580 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
16581 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
16582 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
16583 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
16584
16585 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
16586 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
16587 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
16588 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
16589 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
16590
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090016591 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
16592 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
16593
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016594 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
16595 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
16596 backup connections when going up.
16597
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020016598 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
16599
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016600 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
16601 send or receive data.
16602
16603 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
16604 send or receive data.
16605
16606 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
16607 with nothing left in the buffers.
16608
16609 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
16610
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010016611 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016612 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
16613
16614 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
16615 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
16616 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
16617 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
16618 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
16619
16620 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
16621 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
16622
16623 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
16624 server (HTTP only).
16625
16626 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
16627
16628 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
16629 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
16630 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
16631
16632 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
16633 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
16634 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
16635
16636 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
16637
16638 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
16639 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
16640
16641 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
16642 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
16643 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
16644
16645 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
16646 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020016647 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
16648 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016649
16650 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
16651 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
16652 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
16653 another server.
16654
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016655 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016656 server.
16657
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016658 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
16659 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
16660 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
16661 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16662
16663 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
16664 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
16665 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
16666 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16667
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020016668 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
16669 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
16670 "use-server" rule).
16671
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016672 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16673
16674 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
16675 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
16676
16677 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
16678
16679 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
16680 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
16681 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
16682
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016683 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
16684 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016685 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016686 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
16687 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
16688
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016689 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
16690
16691 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
16692 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
16693
16694 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
16695
16696 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16697
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016698The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
16699was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016700helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
16701starvation, attacks, etc...
16702
16703The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
16704alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
16705easier finding and understanding.
16706
16707 Flags Reason
16708
16709 -- Normal termination.
16710
16711 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
16712 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
16713 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
16714 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
16715
16716 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
16717 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
16718 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
16719 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
16720 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
16721 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016722
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016723 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16724 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016725 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016726
16727 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
16728 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
16729 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
16730
16731 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
16732 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
16733 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
16734 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
16735 the server takes too long to respond.
16736
16737 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
16738 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
16739 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
16740 long a time to respond.
16741
16742 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
16743 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
16744 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
16745 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016746 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
16747 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016748
16749 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
16750 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
16751 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
16752 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
16753 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020016754 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016755 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
16756 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
16757 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
16758 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
16759 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
16760 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
16761 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
16762 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016763 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016764 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
16765 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
16766 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016767
16768 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
16769 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016770 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
16771 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
16772 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
16773 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016774
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016775 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
16776 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
16777
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016778 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016779 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
16780 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016781 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016782 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
16783 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
16784
16785 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
16786 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
16787 503 or 504 here.
16788
16789 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
16790 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
16791 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
16792 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
16793 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
16794
16795 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16796 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016797 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016798 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
16799 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
16800
16801 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
16802 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
16803 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
16804 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
16805 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
16806 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
16807 between haproxy and the server.
16808
16809 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
16810 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
16811 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
16812 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
16813 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
16814 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
16815 solution is to fix the application.
16816
16817 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
16818 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
16819 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
16820 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
16821 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
16822 external attacks.
16823
16824 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
16825 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016826 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016827 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
16828 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
16829
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016830 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
16831 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
16832 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016833 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020016834 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016835
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016836 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
16837 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
16838 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
16839 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016840 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
16841 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
16842 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
16843 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
16844 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016845
16846 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
16847 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
16848 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
16849 returned an HTTP 403 error.
16850
16851 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
16852 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
16853 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
16854 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
16855
16856 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
16857 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
16858 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
16859 only be solved by proper system tuning.
16860
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016861The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
16862persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
16863important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
16864re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16865
16866 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16867
16868 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16869 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16870 set on a GET request.
16871
16872 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16873 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016874 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016875 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16876
16877 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16878 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16879 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16880
16881 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16882 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16883 already got a cookie.
16884
16885 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16886 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16887 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16888 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16889 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16890
16891 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16892 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16893 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16894
16895 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16896 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16897 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16898
16899 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16900 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16901
16902 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16903 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16904 then advertised in the response.
16905
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016906
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169078.6. Non-printable characters
16908-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016909
16910In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16911consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16912converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16913prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16914being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16915escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16916is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16917'}' when logging headers.
16918
16919Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16920issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16921containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16922
16923Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16924the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16925performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16926
16927
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169288.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16929---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016930
16931Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16932achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016933section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016934cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16935the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16936the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016937locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016938not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16939user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16940a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16941wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16942
16943 Examples :
16944 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16945 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16946
16947 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16948 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16949
16950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169518.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16952---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016953
16954Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16955proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16956the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16957server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16958
16959Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
16960response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016961section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016962
16963It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016964time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
16965appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016966are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
16967and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
16968follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
16969request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
16970in the logs.
16971
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016972As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
16973frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
16974an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
16975
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016976 Example :
16977 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
16978 listen proxy-out
16979 mode http
16980 option httplog
16981 option logasap
16982 log global
16983 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
16984
16985 # log the name of the virtual server
16986 capture request header Host len 20
16987
16988 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
16989 capture request header Content-Length len 10
16990
16991 # log the beginning of the referrer
16992 capture request header Referer len 20
16993
16994 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
16995 capture response header Server len 20
16996
16997 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
16998 capture response header Content-Length len 10
16999
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017000 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017001 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17002
17003 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17004 capture response header Via len 20
17005
17006 # log the URL location during a redirection
17007 capture response header Location len 20
17008
17009 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17010 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17011 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17012 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17013 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17014
17015 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17016 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17017 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17018 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017019 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017020
17021 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17022 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17023 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17024 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17025 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017026 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017027
17028
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170298.9. Examples of logs
17030---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017031
17032These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17033them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17034reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17035
17036 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17037 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17038 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17039
17040 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17041 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17042
17043 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17044 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17045 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17046
17047 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17048 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17049
17050 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17051 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17052 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17053
17054 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017055 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017056 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17057 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17058
17059 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17060 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17061 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17062
17063 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
17064 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020017065 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017066 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
17067 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
17068 to return the 502 and not the server.
17069
17070 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017071 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017072
17073 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17074 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17075 Nothing was sent to any server.
17076
17077 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17078 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17079
17080 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17081 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017082 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017083 send a 408 return code to the client.
17084
17085 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17086 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17087
17088 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17089 5 seconds ("c----").
17090
17091 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17092 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017093 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017094
17095 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017096 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017097 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17098 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17099 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17100 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17101 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017102
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017103
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200171049. Supported filters
17105--------------------
17106
17107Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17108accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17109unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17110
17111See also : "filter"
17112
171139.1. Trace
17114----------
17115
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017116filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017117
17118 Arguments:
17119 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17120 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17121
17122 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17123 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17124 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17125 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17126
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017127 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017128 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17129 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17130 amount of the parsed data.
17131
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017132 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017133
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017134This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17135callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17136information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17137filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17138
17139Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17140tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17141a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17142
17143
171449.2. HTTP compression
17145---------------------
17146
17147filter compression
17148
17149The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17150keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
17151when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
17152use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
17153used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
17154filters evaluation order.
17155
17156See also : "compression"
17157
17158
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200171599.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17160--------------------------------------------
17161
17162filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17163
17164 Arguments :
17165
17166 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17167 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17168 parsed.
17169
17170 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17171 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17172 part must be placed in its own scope.
17173
17174The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17175external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017176streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017177exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17178also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17179
17180SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17181the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17182
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017183For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017184"doc/SPOE.txt".
17185
17186Important note:
17187 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17188 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17189
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001719010. Cache
17191---------
17192
17193HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17194(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17195RAM.
17196
17197The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017198this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017199
17200If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17201independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17202when we try to allocate a new one.
17203
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017204The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017205
17206It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17207"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17208for more details.
17209
17210When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17211replaced by "<CACHE>".
17212
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001721310.1. Limitation
17214----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017215
17216The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17217
17218- If the response is not a 200
17219- If the response contains a Vary header
17220- If the response does not contain a Content-Length header or if the
17221 Content-Length + the headers size is greater than a buffer size - the
17222 reserve.
17223- If the response is not cacheable
17224
17225- If the request is not a GET
17226- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
17227
17228Caution!: Due to the current limitation of the filters, it is not recommended
17229to use the cache with other filters. Using them can cause undefined behavior
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017230if they modify the response (compression for example).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017231
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001723210.2. Setup
17233-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017234
17235To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
17236the corresponding http-request and response actions.
17237
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001723810.2.1. Cache section
17239---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017240
17241cache <name>
17242 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
17243 size of cache is mandatory.
17244
17245total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017246 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
17247 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017248
17249max-age <seconds>
17250 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
17251 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
17252 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
17253 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
17254 default.
17255
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001725610.2.2. Proxy section
17257---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017258
17259http-request cache-use <name>
17260 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
17261 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
17262 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
17263 after this one.
17264
17265http-response cache-store <name>
17266 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
17267 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
17268 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
17269 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
17270
17271
17272Example:
17273
17274 backend bck1
17275 mode http
17276
17277 http-request cache-use foobar
17278 http-response cache-store foobar
17279 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
17280
17281 cache foobar
17282 total-max-size 4
17283 max-age 240
17284
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017285/*
17286 * Local variables:
17287 * fill-column: 79
17288 * End:
17289 */